f7c16e9859f4bb9065212adf64217ce85ada24ce
[gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi.in
1 @c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001,
2 @c 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011
3 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 @c This is part of the GCC manual.
5 @c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
6
7 @node Target Macros
8 @chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
9 @cindex machine description macros
10 @cindex target description macros
11 @cindex macros, target description
12 @cindex @file{tm.h} macros
13
14 In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
15 includes a C header file conventionally given the name
16 @file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
17 The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
18 about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
19 @file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
20 @file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
21 @file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
22 source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
23 containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
24 machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
25 if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
26 through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
27
28 @menu
29 * Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
30 * Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
31 * Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
32 * Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
33 * Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
34 * Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
35 * Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
36 * Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
37 * Old Constraints:: The old way to define machine-specific constraints.
38 * Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
39 * Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
40 * Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
41 * Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
42 * Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
43 * Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
44 * Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
45 * Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
46 * Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
47 * Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
48 * PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
49 * Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
50 * Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
51 * Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
52 * Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
53 * Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
54 * Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
55 * MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
56 * PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
57 * C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
58 * Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
59 * Misc:: Everything else.
60 @end menu
61
62 @node Target Structure
63 @section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
64 @cindex target hooks
65 @cindex target functions
66
67 @deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
68 The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
69 which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
70 machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
71 @file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
72 used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
73 for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
74 macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
75 @smallexample
76 #include "target.h"
77 #include "target-def.h"
78
79 /* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
80
81 #undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
82 #define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
83
84 struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
85 @end smallexample
86 @end deftypevar
87
88 Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
89 form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
90 ``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
91 from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
92 @code{targetm} structure.
93
94 Similarly, there is a @code{targetcm} variable for hooks that are
95 specific to front ends for C-family languages, documented as ``C
96 Target Hook''. This is declared in @file{c-family/c-target.h}, the
97 initializer @code{TARGETCM_INITIALIZER} in
98 @file{c-family/c-target-def.h}. If targets initialize @code{targetcm}
99 themselves, they should set @code{target_has_targetcm=yes} in
100 @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default definition is used.
101
102 Similarly, there is a @code{targetm_common} variable for hooks that
103 are shared between the compiler driver and the compilers proper,
104 documented as ``Common Target Hook''. This is declared in
105 @file{common/common-target.h}, the initializer
106 @code{TARGETM_COMMON_INITIALIZER} in
107 @file{common/common-target-def.h}. If targets initialize
108 @code{targetm_common} themselves, they should set
109 @code{target_has_targetm_common=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a
110 default definition is used.
111
112 @node Driver
113 @section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
114 @cindex driver
115 @cindex controlling the compilation driver
116
117 @c prevent bad page break with this line
118 You can control the compilation driver.
119
120 @defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
121 A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
122 initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
123
124 The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
125 default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
126 choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
127 applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
128 options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
129 using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
130
131 This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
132 options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
133 that the other specs are easier to write.
134
135 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
136 @end defmac
137
138 @defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
139 A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
140 @option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
141 for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
142 outermost pair of surrounding braces.
143
144 The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
145 the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
146 to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
147 @samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
148 everywhere it occurs.
149
150 The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
151 default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
152 the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
153
154 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
155 @end defmac
156
157 @defmac CPP_SPEC
158 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
159 pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
160 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
161
162 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
163 @end defmac
164
165 @defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
166 This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
167 than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
168 @code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
169 @end defmac
170
171 @defmac CC1_SPEC
172 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
173 pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
174 front ends.
175 It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
176 for GCC to pass to front ends.
177
178 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
179 @end defmac
180
181 @defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
182 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
183 pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
184 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
185
186 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
187 Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
188 @code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
189 CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
190 @end defmac
191
192 @defmac ASM_SPEC
193 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
194 pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
195 you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
196 See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
197
198 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
199 @end defmac
200
201 @defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
202 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
203 run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
204 Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
205 an example of this.
206
207 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
208 @end defmac
209
210 @defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
211 Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
212 an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
213 read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
214 output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
215 @option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
216
217 If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
218 standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
219 cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
220 see @file{mips.h} for instance.
221 @end defmac
222
223 @defmac LINK_SPEC
224 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
225 pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
226 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
227
228 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
229 @end defmac
230
231 @defmac LIB_SPEC
232 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
233 between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
234 command given to the linker.
235
236 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
237 loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
238 @end defmac
239
240 @defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
241 Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
242 how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
243 linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
244 the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
245
246 If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
247 passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
248 @end defmac
249
250 @defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
251 By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
252 @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
253 instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
254 depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
255 @option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
256 targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
257 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
258 driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
259 line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
260 @end defmac
261
262 @defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
263 A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
264 mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
265 generated that uses --as-needed and the shared libgcc in place of the
266 static exception handler library, when linking without any of
267 @code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
268 @end defmac
269
270 @defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
271 If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
272 When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
273 the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
274 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
275 @end defmac
276
277 @defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
278 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
279 difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
280 the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
281
282 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
283 standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
284 @end defmac
285
286 @defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
287 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
288 difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
289 the very end of the command given to the linker.
290
291 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
292 @end defmac
293
294 @defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
295 GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
296 However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
297 models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
298 @code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
299 blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
300 default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
301 @code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
302 @end defmac
303
304 @defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
305 Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
306 configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
307 et al, within sysroot+suffix.
308 @end defmac
309
310 @defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
311 Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
312 GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
313 updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
314 usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
315 @end defmac
316
317 @defmac EXTRA_SPECS
318 Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
319 @file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
320 @code{CC1_SPEC}.
321
322 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
323 containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
324 string constant that provides the specification.
325
326 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
327
328 @code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
329 related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
330 to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
331 these definitions.
332
333 For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
334 define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
335 used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
336 used.
337
338 The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
339
340 @smallexample
341 #define EXTRA_SPECS \
342 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
343
344 #define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
345 @end smallexample
346
347 The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
348 @smallexample
349 #undef CPP_SPEC
350 #define CPP_SPEC \
351 "%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
352 %@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
353 %@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
354 %@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
355
356 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
357 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
358 @end smallexample
359
360 while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
361 @code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
362
363 @smallexample
364 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
365 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
366 @end smallexample
367 @end defmac
368
369 @defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
370 Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
371 @file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
372 the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
373 @end defmac
374
375 @defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
376 The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
377 By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
378 @end defmac
379
380 @defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
381 A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
382 linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
383 change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
384 define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
385 line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
386 the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
387 @code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
388 @end defmac
389
390 @defmac LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
391 A nonzero value causes @command{collect2} to remove duplicate @option{-L@var{directory}} search
392 directories from linking commands. Do not give it a nonzero value if
393 removing duplicate search directories changes the linker's semantics.
394 @end defmac
395
396 @hook TARGET_ALWAYS_STRIP_DOTDOT
397
398 @defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
399 Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
400 string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
401 target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
402 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
403
404 Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
405 the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
406 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
407 @xref{Target Fragment}.
408 @end defmac
409
410 @defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
411 Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
412 a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
413 indicates an absolute file name.
414 @end defmac
415
416 @defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
417 If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
418 @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
419 when the compiler is built as a cross
420 compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
421 to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
422 @end defmac
423
424 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
425 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
426 standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
427 try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
428 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
429 is built as a cross compiler.
430 @end defmac
431
432 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
433 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
434 standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
435 when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
436 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
437 is built as a cross compiler.
438 @end defmac
439
440 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
441 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
442 standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
443 default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
444 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
445 is built as a cross compiler.
446 @end defmac
447
448 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
449 If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
450 standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
451 compiler is built as a cross compiler.
452 @end defmac
453
454 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
455 If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
456 standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
457 cross compiler.
458 @end defmac
459
460 @defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
461 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
462 variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
463 loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
464 initialize the necessary environment variables.
465 @end defmac
466
467 @defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
468 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
469 standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
470 try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
471 comes before @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
472
473 Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
474 replacement.
475 @end defmac
476
477 @defmac SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR
478 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to specify a
479 system-specific directory to search for header files before the standard
480 directory. @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} comes before
481 @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
482
483 Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search the directory
484 specified.
485 @end defmac
486
487 @defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR
488 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
489 standard choice of @file{/usr/include} as the default prefix to
490 try when searching for header files.
491
492 Cross compilers ignore this macro and do not search either
493 @file{/usr/include} or its replacement.
494 @end defmac
495
496 @defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_COMPONENT
497 The ``component'' corresponding to @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}.
498 See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
499 If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
500 @end defmac
501
502 @defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
503 Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
504 for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
505 usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
506 @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
507 @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
508 and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
509 and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
510 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
511
512 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
513 Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
514 string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
515 for C++-only directories,
516 and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
517 wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
518 the array with a null element.
519
520 The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
521 if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
522 or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
523 operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
524
525 For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
526
527 @smallexample
528 #define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
529 @{ \
530 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
531 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
532 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
533 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
534 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
535 @}
536 @end smallexample
537 @end defmac
538
539 Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
540
541 @enumerate
542 @item
543 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
544
545 @item
546 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
547 is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
548 @var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
549
550 @item
551 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
552
553 @item
554 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
555 in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
556
557 @item
558 The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
559
560 @item
561 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
562
563 @item
564 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
565 compiler.
566 @end enumerate
567
568 Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
569
570 @enumerate
571 @item
572 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
573
574 @item
575 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
576 value based on the installed toolchain location.
577
578 @item
579 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
580 (or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
581
582 @item
583 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
584 in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
585
586 @item
587 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
588
589 @item
590 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
591 compiler.
592
593 @item
594 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
595 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
596
597 @item
598 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
599 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
600
601 @item
602 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
603 If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
604 the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
605
606 @item
607 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
608 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
609 @file{/lib/}.
610
611 @item
612 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
613 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
614 @file{/usr/lib/}.
615 @end enumerate
616
617 @node Run-time Target
618 @section Run-time Target Specification
619 @cindex run-time target specification
620 @cindex predefined macros
621 @cindex target specifications
622
623 @c prevent bad page break with this line
624 Here are run-time target specifications.
625
626 @defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
627 This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
628 built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
629 the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
630 @code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
631 calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
632 finished command line option processing your code can use those
633 results freely.
634
635 @code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
636 command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
637 the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
638 accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
639
640 @code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
641 object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
642 @code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
643 defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
644 with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
645 only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
646 example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
647 and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
648 @code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
649 defines only @code{_ABI64}.
650
651 You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
652 @code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
653 or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
654 assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
655 macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
656 to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
657 variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
658 @code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
659 preprocessing.
660 @end defmac
661
662 @defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
663 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
664 and is used for the target operating system instead.
665 @end defmac
666
667 @defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
668 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
669 and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
670 macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
671 it yourself.
672 @end defmac
673
674 @deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
675 This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
676 any target-specific headers.
677 @end deftypevar
678
679 @hook TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
680 This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
681 Its default setting is 0.
682 @end deftypevr
683
684 @cindex optional hardware or system features
685 @cindex features, optional, in system conventions
686
687 @hook TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION
688 This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
689 target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
690 (@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
691 processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
692 definition does nothing but return true.
693
694 @var{decoded} specifies the option and its arguments. @var{opts} and
695 @var{opts_set} are the @code{gcc_options} structures to be used for
696 storing option state, and @var{loc} is the location at which the
697 option was passed (@code{UNKNOWN_LOCATION} except for options passed
698 via attributes).
699 @end deftypefn
700
701 @hook TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION
702 This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
703 target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
704 definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
705 option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
706 valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
707 default definition does nothing but return false.
708
709 In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
710 options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
711 only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
712 should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
713 @end deftypefn
714
715 @hook TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT
716
717 @hook TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P
718
719 @hook TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG
720
721 @hook TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE
722 This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
723 but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
724 pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
725 attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
726 when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
727 actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
728 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
729 @end deftypefn
730
731 @defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
732 This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
733 but is only used in the C
734 language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
735 used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
736 frontends.
737 @end defmac
738
739 @hook TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
740 Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
741 various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
742 options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
743 options are processed once
744 just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
745 of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
746 options passed explicitly.
747
748 This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
749 options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
750 @code{optimize} attribute.
751 @end deftypevr
752
753 @hook TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT
754
755 @hook TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS
756
757 @defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
758 Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
759 during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
760 the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
761 can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
762 and @code{nomips16} attributes.
763
764 Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
765 registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
766 operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
767 in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
768 significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
769 for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
770 switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
771
772 Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
773 is 0.
774 @end defmac
775
776 @node Per-Function Data
777 @section Defining data structures for per-function information.
778 @cindex per-function data
779 @cindex data structures
780
781 If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
782 provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
783 using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
784 nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
785 when another one comes along.
786
787 GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
788 contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
789 structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
790 @code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
791 to their own specific data.
792
793 If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
794 @code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
795 This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
796 @code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
797
798 One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
799 RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
800 RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
801 function, for level 0.
802
803 Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
804 all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
805 function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
806 stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
807 stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
808 @code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
809 the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
810 single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
811 longer supported.
812
813 @defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
814 Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
815 is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
816 The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
817 function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
818 @end defmac
819
820 @deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
821 If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
822 function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
823 target to perform any target specific initialization of the
824 @code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
825 used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
826
827 @code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
828 Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
829 GC allocation, including the structure itself.
830 @end deftypevar
831
832 @node Storage Layout
833 @section Storage Layout
834 @cindex storage layout
835
836 Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
837 alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
838 expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
839 @xref{Run-time Target}.
840
841 @defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
842 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
843 byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
844 This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
845 bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
846 be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
847 macro need not be a constant.
848
849 This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
850 bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
851 @end defmac
852
853 @defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
854 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
855 word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
856 @end defmac
857
858 @defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
859 Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
860 most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
861 memory locations and registers; GCC fundamentally assumes that the
862 order of words in memory is the same as the order in registers. This
863 macro need not be a constant.
864 @end defmac
865
866 @defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
867 Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
868 @code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
869 containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
870 have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
871
872 You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
873 multi-word integers.
874 @end defmac
875
876 @defmac BITS_PER_UNIT
877 Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
878 unit (byte). If you do not define this macro the default is 8.
879 @end defmac
880
881 @defmac BITS_PER_WORD
882 Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
883 is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
884 @end defmac
885
886 @defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
887 Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
888 @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
889 largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
890 @end defmac
891
892 @defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
893 Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
894 register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
895 @end defmac
896
897 @defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
898 Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
899 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
900 smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
901 @end defmac
902
903 @defmac POINTER_SIZE
904 Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
905 width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
906 you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
907 a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
908 @end defmac
909
910 @defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
911 A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
912 @code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
913 greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
914 should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
915 is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
916 @code{ptr_extend} instruction.
917
918 You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
919 and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
920 @end defmac
921
922 @defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
923 A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
924 is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
925 stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
926 scalar type.
927
928 On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
929 register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
930 @var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
931 cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
932 floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
933 counterparts.
934
935 For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
936 However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
937 either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
938 the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
939 sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
940 @var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
941
942 Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
943 @end defmac
944
945 @hook TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE
946 Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
947 function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
948 and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
949 change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
950 pointer} types.
951
952 @var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
953 return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
954 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
955 If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
956 which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
957 then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
958 the signedness may be different.
959
960 @var{type} can be NULL when promoting function arguments of libcalls.
961
962 The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
963 also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
964 if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
965 @end deftypefn
966
967 @defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
968 Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
969 bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
970 regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
971 size of an integer.
972 @end defmac
973
974 @defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
975 Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
976 stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
977 desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
978 if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
979 this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
980 @end defmac
981
982 @defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
983 Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
984 stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
985 is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
986 macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
987 @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
988 @end defmac
989
990 @defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
991 Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
992 from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
993 to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
994 @end defmac
995
996 @defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
997 Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
998 @end defmac
999
1000 @defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1001 Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1002 bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1003 just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
1004 @end defmac
1005
1006 @defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1007 Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1008 provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1009 @end defmac
1010
1011 @defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1012 Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1013 not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1014 @end defmac
1015
1016 @defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1017 If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1018 object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1019 nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1020 on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1021 @end defmac
1022
1023 @defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1024 Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1025 machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1026 structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1027 by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1028 @end defmac
1029
1030 @defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1031 An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1032 alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1033 @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1034 alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1035 field alignment has not been set by the
1036 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1037 @end defmac
1038
1039 @defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1040 Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1041 to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1042
1043 If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1044
1045 @c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1046 @c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1047 @c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1048 @c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1049 @end defmac
1050
1051 @defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1052 Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1053 Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1054 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1055 the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1056
1057 On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1058 the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1059 a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((unsigned HOST_WIDEST_INT) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1060 On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1061 @samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1062 @end defmac
1063
1064 @defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1065 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1066 the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1067 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1068 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1069
1070 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1071
1072 @findex strcpy
1073 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1074 make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1075 arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1076 constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1077 @end defmac
1078
1079 @defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1080 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1081 that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1082 @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1083 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1084 align the object.
1085
1086 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1087
1088 The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1089 constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1090 constants can be done inline.
1091 @end defmac
1092
1093 @defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1094 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1095 the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1096 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1097 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1098
1099 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1100
1101 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1102 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1103
1104 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1105 @end defmac
1106
1107 @defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1108 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1109 @var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1110 and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1111 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1112 align the slot.
1113
1114 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1115 @var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1116 be used.
1117
1118 This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1119 of all possible modes which the slot may have.
1120
1121 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1122 @end defmac
1123
1124 @defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1125 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1126 variable @var{decl}.
1127
1128 If this macro is not defined, then
1129 @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1130 is used.
1131
1132 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1133 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1134
1135 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1136 @end defmac
1137
1138 @defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1139 If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1140 for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1141 @var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1142
1143 If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1144 @end defmac
1145
1146 @defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1147 Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1148 empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1149
1150 If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1151 @end defmac
1152
1153 @defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1154 Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1155 Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1156
1157 If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1158 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1159 @end defmac
1160
1161 @defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1162 Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1163 if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1164 go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1165 @end defmac
1166
1167 @defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1168 Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1169 alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1170
1171 The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1172 @code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1173 structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1174 that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1175 that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1176
1177 Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1178 @code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1179 four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1180 not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1181
1182 An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1183 structure.
1184
1185 If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1186 a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1187
1188 Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1189 bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1190 support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1191 @samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1192
1193 The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1194 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1195 Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1196
1197 Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1198 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1199 @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1200
1201 If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1202 bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1203 what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1204
1205 @smallexample
1206 struct foo1
1207 @{
1208 char x;
1209 char :0;
1210 char y;
1211 @};
1212
1213 struct foo2
1214 @{
1215 char x;
1216 int :0;
1217 char y;
1218 @};
1219
1220 main ()
1221 @{
1222 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1223 sizeof (struct foo1));
1224 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1225 sizeof (struct foo2));
1226 exit (0);
1227 @}
1228 @end smallexample
1229
1230 If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1231 get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1232 @end defmac
1233
1234 @defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1235 Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1236 to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1237 @end defmac
1238
1239 @hook TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD
1240 When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1241 whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1242 structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1243 the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1244 @end deftypefn
1245
1246 @hook TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD
1247 This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1248 should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1249 these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1250
1251 The default is @code{!TARGET_STRICT_ALIGN}.
1252 @end deftypefn
1253
1254 @defmac MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (@var{field}, @var{mode})
1255 Return 1 if a structure or array containing @var{field} should be accessed using
1256 @code{BLKMODE}.
1257
1258 If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1259 mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1260 case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1261 retain the field's mode.
1262
1263 Normally, this is not needed.
1264 @end defmac
1265
1266 @defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1267 Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1268 by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1269 way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1270 @var{specified}.
1271
1272 The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1273 the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1274 @end defmac
1275
1276 @defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1277 An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1278 machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1279 this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1280 appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1281 (DImode)} is assumed.
1282 @end defmac
1283
1284 @defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1285 If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1286 specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1287 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1288 @var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1289 @code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1290 having its mode specified.
1291
1292 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1293 would most commonly define this macro if the
1294 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
1295 64-bit mode.
1296 @end defmac
1297
1298 @defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1299 If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1300 specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1301 @code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1302
1303 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1304 You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1305 pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1306 @end defmac
1307
1308 @hook TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE
1309 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1310 of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1311 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1312 targets.
1313 @end deftypefn
1314
1315 @hook TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE
1316 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1317 of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1318 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1319 targets.
1320 @end deftypefn
1321
1322 @hook TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE
1323 Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1324 The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1325 @end deftypefn
1326
1327 @defmac ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
1328 If defined, this macro should be true if the prevailing rounding
1329 mode is towards zero.
1330
1331 Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1332 floating-point arithmetic.
1333
1334 Not defining this macro is equivalent to returning zero.
1335 @end defmac
1336
1337 @defmac LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL (@var{size})
1338 This macro should return true if floats with @var{size}
1339 bits do not have a NaN or infinity representation, but use the largest
1340 exponent for normal numbers instead.
1341
1342 Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1343 floating-point arithmetic.
1344
1345 The default definition of this macro returns false for all sizes.
1346 @end defmac
1347
1348 @hook TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P
1349 This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1350 @var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1351 Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1352 unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1353 different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1354 alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1355 bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1356 the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1357 (iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1358 another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1359 other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1360
1361 When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1362 of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1363 bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1364 and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1365 chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1366 size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1367 alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1368
1369 If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1370 the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1371 used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1372 precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1373 may affect its placement.
1374 @end deftypefn
1375
1376 @hook TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P
1377 Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1378 @end deftypefn
1379
1380 @hook TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P
1381 Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1382 @end deftypefn
1383
1384 @hook TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK
1385 This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1386 to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1387 For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1388 for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1389 registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1390 usage.
1391 @end deftypefn
1392
1393 @hook TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS
1394 This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1395 that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1396 @end deftypefn
1397
1398 @hook TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE
1399 If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1400 uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1401 to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1402 mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1403 the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1404 not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1405 for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1406 return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1407 string constant.
1408
1409 Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1410 qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1411 fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1412 is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1413 length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1414 ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1415 @var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1416 @var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1417 code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1418 @code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1419 codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1420 spaces in your string.
1421
1422 This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1423 name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1424 can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1425 before mangling.
1426
1427 The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1428 appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1429 types.
1430 @end deftypefn
1431
1432 @node Type Layout
1433 @section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1434
1435 These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1436 basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1437 the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1438 languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1439
1440 @defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1441 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1442 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1443 @end defmac
1444
1445 @defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1446 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1447 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1448 (If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1449 unit.)
1450 @end defmac
1451
1452 @defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1453 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1454 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1455 @end defmac
1456
1457 @defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1458 On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1459 @code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1460 that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1461 the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1462 value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1463 @end defmac
1464
1465 @defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1466 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1467 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1468 words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1469 macro must be at least 64.
1470 @end defmac
1471
1472 @defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1473 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1474 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1475 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1476 @end defmac
1477
1478 @defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1479 A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1480 C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1481 this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1482 @end defmac
1483
1484 @defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1485 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1486 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1487 @end defmac
1488
1489 @defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1490 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1491 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1492 words.
1493 @end defmac
1494
1495 @defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1496 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1497 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1498 words.
1499 @end defmac
1500
1501 @defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1502 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1503 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1504 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1505 @end defmac
1506
1507 @defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1508 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1509 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1510 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1511 @end defmac
1512
1513 @defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1514 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1515 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1516 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1517 @end defmac
1518
1519 @defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1520 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1521 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1522 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1523 @end defmac
1524
1525 @defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1526 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1527 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1528 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1529 @end defmac
1530
1531 @defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1532 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1533 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1534 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1535 @end defmac
1536
1537 @defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1538 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1539 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1540 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1541 @end defmac
1542
1543 @defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1544 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1545 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1546 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1547 @end defmac
1548
1549 @defmac LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1550 Define this macro if @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not constant or
1551 if you want routines in @file{libgcc2.a} for a size other than
1552 @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}. If you don't define this, the
1553 default is @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1554 @end defmac
1555
1556 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_DF_MODE
1557 Define this macro if neither @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} nor
1558 @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is
1559 @code{DFmode} but you want @code{DFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1560 anyway. If you don't define this and either @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1561 or @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64 then the default is 1,
1562 otherwise it is 0.
1563 @end defmac
1564
1565 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_XF_MODE
1566 Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1567 @code{XFmode} but you want @code{XFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1568 anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1569 is 80 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1570 @end defmac
1571
1572 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_TF_MODE
1573 Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1574 @code{TFmode} but you want @code{TFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1575 anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1576 is 128 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1577 @end defmac
1578
1579 @defmac LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX
1580 This macro corresponds to the @code{TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX} target
1581 hook and should be defined if that hook is overriden to be true. It
1582 causes function names in libgcc to be changed to use a @code{__gnu_}
1583 prefix for their name rather than the default @code{__}. A port which
1584 uses this macro should also arrange to use @file{t-gnu-prefix} in
1585 the libgcc @file{config.host}.
1586 @end defmac
1587
1588 @defmac SF_SIZE
1589 @defmacx DF_SIZE
1590 @defmacx XF_SIZE
1591 @defmacx TF_SIZE
1592 Define these macros to be the size in bits of the mantissa of
1593 @code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} values,
1594 if the defaults in @file{libgcc2.h} are inappropriate. By default,
1595 @code{FLT_MANT_DIG} is used for @code{SF_SIZE}, @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG}
1596 for @code{XF_SIZE} and @code{TF_SIZE}, and @code{DBL_MANT_DIG} or
1597 @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG} for @code{DF_SIZE} according to whether
1598 @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} or
1599 @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64.
1600 @end defmac
1601
1602 @defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1603 A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1604 assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1605 default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1606 @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1607 @end defmac
1608
1609 @defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1610 A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1611 supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1612 value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1613 If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1614 is the default.
1615 @end defmac
1616
1617 @defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1618 An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1619 @code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1620 always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1621 and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1622 @end defmac
1623
1624 @hook TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
1625 This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1626 @code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1627 of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
1628 @code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1629
1630 The default is to return false.
1631 @end deftypefn
1632
1633 @defmac SIZE_TYPE
1634 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1635 for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1636 contents of the string.
1637
1638 The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1639 spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1640 appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1641 of the data type names defined in the function
1642 @code{init_decl_processing} in the file @file{c-decl.c}. You may not
1643 omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the compiler to
1644 crash on startup.
1645
1646 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1647 int"}.
1648 @end defmac
1649
1650 @defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1651 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1652 for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1653 @code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1654 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1655
1656 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1657 @end defmac
1658
1659 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1660 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1661 for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1662 the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1663 information.
1664
1665 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1666 @end defmac
1667
1668 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1669 A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1670 characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1671 @code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1672 @end defmac
1673
1674 @defmac WINT_TYPE
1675 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1676 use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1677 @code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1678 contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1679 information.
1680
1681 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1682 @end defmac
1683
1684 @defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1685 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1686 can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1687 The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1688 string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1689
1690 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1691 @code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1692 much precision as @code{long long int}.
1693 @end defmac
1694
1695 @defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1696 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1697 can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1698 type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1699 of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1700
1701 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1702 @code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1703 unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1704 int}.
1705 @end defmac
1706
1707 @defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1708 @defmacx INT8_TYPE
1709 @defmacx INT16_TYPE
1710 @defmacx INT32_TYPE
1711 @defmacx INT64_TYPE
1712 @defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1713 @defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1714 @defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1715 @defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1716 @defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1717 @defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1718 @defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1719 @defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1720 @defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1721 @defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1722 @defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1723 @defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1724 @defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1725 @defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1726 @defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1727 @defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1728 @defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1729 @defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1730 @defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1731 @defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1732 @defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1733 @defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1734 C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1735 @code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1736 @code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1737 @code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1738 @code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1739 @code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1740 @code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1741 @code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1742 @code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1743 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1744
1745 If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1746 type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1747 @code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1748 to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1749 these macros are null pointers.
1750 @end defmac
1751
1752 @defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1753 The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1754 that looks like:
1755
1756 @smallexample
1757 struct @{
1758 union @{
1759 void (*fn)();
1760 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1761 @};
1762 ptrdiff_t delta;
1763 @};
1764 @end smallexample
1765
1766 @noindent
1767 The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1768 will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1769 Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1770 always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1771 distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1772 platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1773 that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1774 the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1775
1776 GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1777 this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1778 However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1779 set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1780 bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1781 address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1782 architecture, you should define this macro to
1783 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1784
1785 In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1786 in which function addresses are always even, according to
1787 @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1788 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1789 @end defmac
1790
1791 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1792 Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1793 macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1794 instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1795 function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1796 data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1797 pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1798
1799 If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1800 of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1801 @end defmac
1802
1803 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1804 By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1805 is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1806 the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1807 when special alignment is necessary. */
1808 @end defmac
1809
1810 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1811 There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1812 zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1813 specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1814 of words in each data entry.
1815 @end defmac
1816
1817 @node Registers
1818 @section Register Usage
1819 @cindex register usage
1820
1821 This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1822 has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1823
1824 The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1825 done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1826 on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1827 For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1828 For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1829
1830 @menu
1831 * Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1832 * Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1833 * Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1834 * Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1835 * Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1836 @end menu
1837
1838 @node Register Basics
1839 @subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1840
1841 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1842 Registers have various characteristics.
1843
1844 @defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1845 Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1846 numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1847 pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1848 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1849 @end defmac
1850
1851 @defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1852 @cindex fixed register
1853 An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1854 all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1855 general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1856 pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1857 register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1858 machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1859 and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1860
1861 This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1862 commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1863 register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1864
1865 The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1866 the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1867 by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1868 the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1869 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1870 @end defmac
1871
1872 @defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1873 @cindex call-used register
1874 @cindex call-clobbered register
1875 @cindex call-saved register
1876 Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1877 clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1878 registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1879 available for general allocation of values that must live across
1880 function calls.
1881
1882 If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1883 automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1884 exit, if the register is used within the function.
1885 @end defmac
1886
1887 @defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1888 @cindex call-used register
1889 @cindex call-clobbered register
1890 @cindex call-saved register
1891 Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1892 that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1893 (@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1894 This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1895 of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1896 @end defmac
1897
1898 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1899 @cindex call-used register
1900 @cindex call-clobbered register
1901 @cindex call-saved register
1902 A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1903 value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1904 call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1905 macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1906 preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1907 @end defmac
1908
1909 @findex fixed_regs
1910 @findex call_used_regs
1911 @findex global_regs
1912 @findex reg_names
1913 @findex reg_class_contents
1914 @hook TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
1915 This hook may conditionally modify five variables
1916 @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1917 @code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1918 any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1919 of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1920 @code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1921 @code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1922 called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1923 @code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1924 from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1925 @code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1926 @code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1927 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1928 command options have been applied.
1929
1930 @cindex disabling certain registers
1931 @cindex controlling register usage
1932 If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1933 flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1934 @code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1935 registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also define
1936 the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} / @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
1937 to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
1938 is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
1939
1940 (However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1941 of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1942 controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1943 these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
1944 @end deftypefn
1945
1946 @defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1947 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1948 expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1949 corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1950 function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1951 outbound register.
1952 @end defmac
1953
1954 @defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1955 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1956 expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1957 corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1958 function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1959 register.
1960 @end defmac
1961
1962 @defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1963 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1964 expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1965 register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1966 need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1967 gotos.
1968 @end defmac
1969
1970 @defmac PC_REGNUM
1971 If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1972 register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
1973 @end defmac
1974
1975 @node Allocation Order
1976 @subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1977 @cindex order of register allocation
1978 @cindex register allocation order
1979
1980 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1981 Registers are allocated in order.
1982
1983 @defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1984 If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
1985 numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
1986 to use them (from most preferred to least).
1987
1988 If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1989 (all else being equal).
1990
1991 One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1992 registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1993 instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
1994 machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
1995 the highest numbered allocable register first.
1996 @end defmac
1997
1998 @defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1999 A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
2000 hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
2001
2002 Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
2003 Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
2004 register; and so on.
2005
2006 The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
2007 @code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
2008
2009 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2010 @end defmac
2011
2012 @defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2013 Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
2014 prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
2015 using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
2016 allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
2017 call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, this macro
2018 should be defined.
2019 @end defmac
2020
2021 @defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
2022 In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
2023 Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
2024 If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
2025 based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2026 be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2027 value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2028 to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2029
2030 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2031 @end defmac
2032
2033 @node Values in Registers
2034 @subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2035
2036 This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2037 (specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2038 consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2039
2040 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2041 A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2042 at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2043 @var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2044 cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2045 and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
2046
2047 On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2048 definition of this macro is
2049
2050 @smallexample
2051 #define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2052 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
2053 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2054 @end smallexample
2055 @end defmac
2056
2057 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2058 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2059 in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2060 in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2061 multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2062 this mode by the number of registers returned by
2063 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2064
2065 For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2066 registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2067 nonzero.
2068
2069 This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2070 @code{subreg_get_info}
2071 would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2072 represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2073 @code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2074 registers and so not be representable.
2075 @end defmac
2076
2077 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2078 For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2079 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2080 returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2081 including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2082 @end defmac
2083
2084 @defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2085 Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2086 of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2087 should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2088 used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2089 happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2090 floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2091 @end defmac
2092
2093 @defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2094 A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2095 of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2096 registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2097 are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2098
2099 @smallexample
2100 #define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2101 @end smallexample
2102
2103 You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2104 because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2105
2106 @cindex register pairs
2107 On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2108 register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2109 odd register numbers for such modes.
2110
2111 The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2112 @samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2113 register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2114 value into the register and back out not alter it.
2115
2116 Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2117 all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2118 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2119 you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2120 is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2121 and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2122 to be tieable.
2123
2124 Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2125 Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2126 in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2127 can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2128 mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2129 registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2130
2131 On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2132 modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2133 registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2134 non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2135 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2136 floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2137 normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2138 unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2139 register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2140
2141 The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2142 they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2143 instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2144 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2145 constraints for those instructions.
2146
2147 On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2148 so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2149 register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2150 floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2151 be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2152 @end defmac
2153
2154 @defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2155 A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2156 @var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2157
2158 One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2159 another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2160 handler.
2161
2162 The default is always nonzero.
2163 @end defmac
2164
2165 @defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2166 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2167 @var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2168
2169 If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2170 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2171 any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2172 should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2173 this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2174 accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2175
2176 You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2177 possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2178 allocation.
2179 @end defmac
2180
2181 @hook TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK
2182 This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2183 @var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2184
2185 One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2186 is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2187
2188 The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2189 @end deftypefn
2190
2191 @defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2192 Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2193 registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2194 @code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2195 @end defmac
2196
2197 @node Leaf Functions
2198 @subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2199
2200 @cindex leaf functions
2201 @cindex functions, leaf
2202 On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2203 more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2204 means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2205 are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2206 normally arrive.
2207
2208 The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2209 other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2210 registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2211 function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2212 handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2213 functions''.
2214
2215 GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2216 suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2217 registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2218 accomplish this.
2219
2220 @defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2221 Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2222 contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2223 function treatment.
2224
2225 If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2226 registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2227 GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2228 used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2229 in this vector.
2230
2231 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2232 the treatment of leaf functions.
2233 @end defmac
2234
2235 @defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2236 A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2237 should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2238
2239 If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2240 function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2241 will cause the compiler to abort.
2242
2243 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2244 treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2245 this.
2246 @end defmac
2247
2248 @findex current_function_is_leaf
2249 @findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2250 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2251 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2252 specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2253 which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2254 set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2255 compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2256 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2257 functions which only use leaf registers.
2258 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2259 that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2260 @code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2261 @c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2262 @c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2263
2264 @node Stack Registers
2265 @subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2266
2267 There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2268 ``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2269 pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2270 stack.
2271
2272 Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2273 they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2274 support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2275 point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2276 stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2277 @file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2278 with it, as well as defining these macros.
2279
2280 @defmac STACK_REGS
2281 Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2282 @end defmac
2283
2284 @defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2285 This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2286 the machine has any stack-like registers.
2287 @end defmac
2288
2289 @defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2290 The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2291 of the stack.
2292 @end defmac
2293
2294 @defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2295 The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2296 the stack.
2297 @end defmac
2298
2299 @node Register Classes
2300 @section Register Classes
2301 @cindex register class definitions
2302 @cindex class definitions, register
2303
2304 On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2305 For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2306 certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2307 restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2308
2309 You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2310 which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2311 that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2312
2313 @findex ALL_REGS
2314 @findex NO_REGS
2315 In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2316 class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2317 class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2318 union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2319
2320 @findex GENERAL_REGS
2321 One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2322 terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2323 @samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2324 the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2325 to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2326
2327 Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2328 then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2329
2330 The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2331 constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2332 You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2333 them in operand constraints.
2334
2335 You must define the narrowest register classes for allocatable
2336 registers, so that each class either has no subclasses, or that for
2337 some mode, the move cost between registers within the class is
2338 cheaper than moving a register in the class to or from memory
2339 (@pxref{Costs}).
2340
2341 You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2342 instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2343 either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2344 certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2345 which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code,
2346 or even internal compiler errors when reload cannot find a register in the
2347 class computed via @code{reg_class_subunion}.
2348
2349 You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2350 classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2351 contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2352 in their union.
2353
2354 When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2355 certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2356 Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2357 a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2358 specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2359
2360 Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2361 instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2362 each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2363 mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2364 single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2365 this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2366 instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2367 single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2368 @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2369
2370 @deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2371 An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2372 as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2373 must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2374 @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2375 tells how many classes there are.
2376
2377 Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2378 the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2379 in many of the tables described below.
2380 @end deftp
2381
2382 @defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2383 The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2384
2385 @smallexample
2386 #define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2387 @end smallexample
2388 @end defmac
2389
2390 @defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2391 An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2392 constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2393 @end defmac
2394
2395 @defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2396 An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2397 which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2398 @var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2399 register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2400
2401 When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2402 Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2403 several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2404 for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2405 In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2406 registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2407 so on.
2408 @end defmac
2409
2410 @defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2411 A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2412 @var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2413 which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2414 register.
2415 @end defmac
2416
2417 @defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2418 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2419 base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2420 which is the register value plus a displacement.
2421 @end defmac
2422
2423 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2424 This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2425 the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2426 @var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2427 @code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2428 @end defmac
2429
2430 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2431 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2432 base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2433 register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2434 addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2435 @end defmac
2436
2437 @defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2438 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2439 base register must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code} define the
2440 context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is the code of
2441 the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level of an
2442 address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2443 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2444 index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2445 @end defmac
2446
2447 @defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2448 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2449 index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2450 address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2451 added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2452 @end defmac
2453
2454 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2455 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2456 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
2457 @end defmac
2458
2459 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2460 A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2461 that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2462 @var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2463 reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2464 you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2465 @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2466 addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2467 @code{address_operand}.
2468 @end defmac
2469
2470 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2471 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2472 use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2473 memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2474 pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2475 define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2476 than other base register uses.
2477
2478 Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2479 @code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2480 @end defmac
2481
2482 @defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2483 A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2484 that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2485 appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2486 immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2487 address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2488 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2489 corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2490 @code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2491 that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
2492 @end defmac
2493
2494 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2495 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2496 suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2497 either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2498 allocated such a hard register.
2499
2500 The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2501 the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2502 two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2503 labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2504 labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2505 may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2506 looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2507 only if neither labeling works.
2508 @end defmac
2509
2510 @hook TARGET_PREFERRED_RENAME_CLASS
2511
2512 @hook TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS
2513 A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2514 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2515 @var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2516 another, smaller class.
2517
2518 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2519
2520 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2521 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2522 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2523 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2524 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2525
2526 One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2527 @var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2528 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2529 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2530 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2531 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2532 register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2533 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2534 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2535 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2536 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2537
2538 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2539 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2540 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2541 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2542 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2543 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2544 @end deftypefn
2545
2546 @defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2547 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2548 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2549 @var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2550 another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2551 safe:
2552
2553 @smallexample
2554 #define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2555 @end smallexample
2556
2557 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2558 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2559 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2560 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2561 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2562
2563 One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2564 @var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2565 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2566 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2567 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2568 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2569 register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2570 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2571 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2572 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2573 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2574
2575 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2576 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2577 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2578 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2579 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2580 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2581 @end defmac
2582
2583 @defmac PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2584 Like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2585 input reloads. If you don't define this macro, the default is to use
2586 @var{class}, unchanged.
2587
2588 You can also use @code{PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2589 reload from using some alternatives, like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2590 @end defmac
2591
2592 @hook TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2593 Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2594 input reloads.
2595
2596 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2597 argument.
2598
2599 You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2600 reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2601 @end deftypefn
2602
2603 @defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2604 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2605 to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2606 @var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2607 ordinarily be used.
2608
2609 Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2610 there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2611
2612 The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2613 smaller class.
2614
2615 Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2616 require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2617 @end defmac
2618
2619 @hook TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD
2620 Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2621 from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2622 @samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2623 from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2624 term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2625 directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2626 register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2627 destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2628 source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2629 reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2630 and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2631 intermediate register still holds the required value.
2632
2633 Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2634 allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2635 register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2636 address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2637 when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2638 as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2639 that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2640 describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2641 these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2642 of the scratch register(s).
2643
2644 In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2645
2646 For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2647 and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2648 @var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
2649 hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2650 needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2651
2652 If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2653 an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2654 return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2655 If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2656 If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2657 that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2658
2659 If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2660 perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2661 closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2662 required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2663 copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2664
2665 You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2666 in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2667 and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2668 for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2669 single-register-class
2670 @c [later: or memory]
2671 output constraint.
2672
2673 When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2674 hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2675 register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2676 have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2677
2678 @c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2679 @c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2680 @c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2681 @c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2682 @c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2683 @c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2684 @c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2685 @c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2686
2687
2688 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2689 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2690 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2691 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2692
2693 Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2694 currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2695 to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2696
2697 @code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2698 copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2699 (a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2700 Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2701 of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2702 forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2703 @end deftypefn
2704
2705 @defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2706 @defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2707 @defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2708 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2709 @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2710
2711 These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2712 target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2713 reload phase that it may
2714 need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2715 register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2716 register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2717 you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2718 largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2719 intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2720
2721 If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2722 intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2723 was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2724 class required. If the
2725 requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2726 @code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2727 macros identically.
2728
2729 The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2730 Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2731 can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2732 @var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2733 macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2734
2735 If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2736 intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2737 @samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2738 (@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
2739 implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2740 @samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2741 register.
2742
2743 These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2744 register that
2745 contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2746 class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2747 value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2748 register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2749 Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2750
2751 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2752 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2753 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2754 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2755
2756 These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2757 registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2758 registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2759 would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2760 the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2761 intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2762 general registers.
2763 @end defmac
2764
2765 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2766 Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2767 to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2768 those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2769 @var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2770 class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2771 and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2772
2773 Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2774 @end defmac
2775
2776 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2777 Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2778 allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2779 If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2780 defined by this macro.
2781
2782 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2783 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2784 @end defmac
2785
2786 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2787 When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2788 registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2789 hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2790 load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2791 same as that of @var{mode}.
2792
2793 This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2794 bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2795 in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2796 registers.
2797
2798 However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2799 the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2800 differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2801 widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2802 suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2803 details.
2804
2805 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2806 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2807 is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2808 @end defmac
2809
2810 @hook TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P
2811 A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2812 to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2813 registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2814
2815 The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2816 has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
2817 default should be used. Only use this target hook to some other expression
2818 if pseudos allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their
2819 hard registers were needed for spill registers. If this target hook returns
2820 @code{false} for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
2821 @file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
2822 register. If there would not be another register available for reallocation,
2823 you should not change the implementation of this target hook since
2824 the only effect of such implementation would be to slow down register
2825 allocation.
2826 @end deftypefn
2827
2828 @defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2829 A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2830 of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2831
2832 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2833 the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2834 should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2835 @var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2836
2837 This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2838 in the reload pass.
2839 @end defmac
2840
2841 @defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2842 If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2843 a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2844
2845 For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2846 floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2847 Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2848 does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2849 register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2850 as below:
2851
2852 @smallexample
2853 #define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2854 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2855 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2856 @end smallexample
2857 @end defmac
2858
2859 @node Old Constraints
2860 @section Obsolete Macros for Defining Constraints
2861 @cindex defining constraints, obsolete method
2862 @cindex constraints, defining, obsolete method
2863
2864 Machine-specific constraints can be defined with these macros instead
2865 of the machine description constructs described in @ref{Define
2866 Constraints}. This mechanism is obsolete. New ports should not use
2867 it; old ports should convert to the new mechanism.
2868
2869 @defmac CONSTRAINT_LEN (@var{char}, @var{str})
2870 For the constraint at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter
2871 @var{c}, return the length. This allows you to have register class /
2872 constant / extra constraints that are longer than a single letter;
2873 you don't need to define this macro if you can do with single-letter
2874 constraints only. The definition of this macro should use
2875 DEFAULT_CONSTRAINT_LEN for all the characters that you don't want
2876 to handle specially.
2877 There are some sanity checks in genoutput.c that check the constraint lengths
2878 for the md file, so you can also use this macro to help you while you are
2879 transitioning from a byzantine single-letter-constraint scheme: when you
2880 return a negative length for a constraint you want to re-use, genoutput
2881 will complain about every instance where it is used in the md file.
2882 @end defmac
2883
2884 @defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2885 A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2886 letters for register classes. If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2887 value should be the register class corresponding to it. Otherwise,
2888 the value should be @code{NO_REGS}. The register letter @samp{r},
2889 corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2890 to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2891 @end defmac
2892
2893 @defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (@var{char}, @var{str})
2894 Like @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}, but you also get the constraint string
2895 passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between
2896 different variants.
2897 @end defmac
2898
2899 @defmac CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2900 A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2901 letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2902 particular ranges of integer values. If @var{c} is one of those
2903 letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2904 the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is
2905 not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2906 @var{value}.
2907 @end defmac
2908
2909 @defmac CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2910 Like @code{CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2911 string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2912 between different variants.
2913 @end defmac
2914
2915 @defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2916 A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2917 letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2918 (@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
2919
2920 If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2921 @var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2922 range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is not one of those
2923 letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2924
2925 @code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2926 @code{DImode} fixed-point constants. A given letter can accept either
2927 or both kinds of values. It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2928 between these kinds.
2929 @end defmac
2930
2931 @defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2932 Like @code{CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2933 string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2934 between different variants.
2935 @end defmac
2936
2937 @defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
2938 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2939 letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
2940 memory references, for the target machine. Any letter that is not
2941 elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} /
2942 @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
2943 may be used. Normally this macro will not be defined.
2944
2945 If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
2946 if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
2947 constraint letter @var{c}. If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
2948 constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2949
2950 For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
2951 in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address. Constraint
2952 letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
2953 @emph{not} contain a symbolic address. An alternative is specified with
2954 a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output. The next
2955 alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
2956 does not include r0 on the output.
2957 @end defmac
2958
2959 @defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2960 Like @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, but you also get the constraint string passed
2961 in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between different
2962 variants.
2963 @end defmac
2964
2965 @defmac EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2966 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2967 letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, that should
2968 be treated like memory constraints by the reload pass.
2969
2970 It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
2971 at the start of @var{str}, the first letter of which is the letter @var{c},
2972 comprises a subset of all memory references including
2973 all those whose address is simply a base register. This allows the reload
2974 pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
2975 type of @var{c}, by copying its address into a base register.
2976
2977 For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
2978 memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
2979 register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined via
2980 @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} as representing a memory address of this type.
2981 If the letter @samp{Q} is marked as @code{EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT},
2982 a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any memory operand, because the
2983 reload pass knows it can be reloaded by copying the memory address
2984 into a base register if required. This is analogous to the way
2985 an @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
2986 @end defmac
2987
2988 @defmac EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2989 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2990 letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} /
2991 @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR}, that should
2992 be treated like address constraints by the reload pass.
2993
2994 It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
2995 at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter @var{c}, comprises
2996 a subset of all memory addresses including
2997 all those that consist of just a base register. This allows the reload
2998 pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
2999 type of @var{str}, by copying it into a base register.
3000
3001 Any constraint marked as @code{EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT} can only
3002 be used with the @code{address_operand} predicate. It is treated
3003 analogously to the @samp{p} constraint.
3004 @end defmac
3005
3006 @node Stack and Calling
3007 @section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
3008 @cindex calling conventions
3009
3010 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3011 This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
3012
3013 @menu
3014 * Frame Layout::
3015 * Exception Handling::
3016 * Stack Checking::
3017 * Frame Registers::
3018 * Elimination::
3019 * Stack Arguments::
3020 * Register Arguments::
3021 * Scalar Return::
3022 * Aggregate Return::
3023 * Caller Saves::
3024 * Function Entry::
3025 * Profiling::
3026 * Tail Calls::
3027 * Stack Smashing Protection::
3028 @end menu
3029
3030 @node Frame Layout
3031 @subsection Basic Stack Layout
3032 @cindex stack frame layout
3033 @cindex frame layout
3034
3035 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3036 Here is the basic stack layout.
3037
3038 @defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3039 Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
3040 pointer to a smaller address.
3041
3042 When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{}'', it means that the
3043 compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
3044 definition used does not matter.
3045 @end defmac
3046
3047 @defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
3048 This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
3049 on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
3050 @code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
3051
3052 The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
3053 and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
3054 the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
3055 to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
3056 space for the next item on the stack.
3057
3058 The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
3059 defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
3060 which is often wrong.
3061 @end defmac
3062
3063 @defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3064 Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
3065 are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
3066 @end defmac
3067
3068 @defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
3069 Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
3070 addresses on the stack.
3071 @end defmac
3072
3073 @defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
3074 Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
3075
3076 If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
3077 subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3078 Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
3079 value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3080 @c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
3081 @c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
3082 @end defmac
3083
3084 @defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
3085 Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
3086 The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3087
3088 On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
3089 is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
3090 alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
3091 stack alignment and do it in the backend.
3092 @end defmac
3093
3094 @defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
3095 Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
3096 outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
3097 zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
3098
3099 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3100 the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
3101 @end defmac
3102
3103 @defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3104 Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3105 address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3106 function.
3107
3108 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3109 the first argument's address.
3110 @end defmac
3111
3112 @defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3113 Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3114 on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3115
3116 The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3117 length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3118 machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
3119 @end defmac
3120
3121 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3122 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3123 stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3124 @code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3125 default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3126 elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3127 @code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3128 @end defmac
3129
3130 @defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3131 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3132 frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3133 @var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3134 itself.
3135
3136 If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3137 of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3138 address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3139 @end defmac
3140
3141 @defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3142 If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3143 setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
3144 on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3145 before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3146 define this macro.
3147 @end defmac
3148
3149 @hook TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE
3150 This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3151 the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3152 The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3153 machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3154 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3155 @end deftypefn
3156
3157 @defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3158 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3159 address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3160 of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3161 You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3162 as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3163 @end defmac
3164
3165 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3166 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3167 address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3168 the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3169 frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3170 @code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
3171
3172 The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3173 @var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3174 determine the return address of other frames.
3175 @end defmac
3176
3177 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3178 Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
3179 from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
3180 @end defmac
3181
3182 @defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3183 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3184 incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3185 prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3186 value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3187 the stack.
3188
3189 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3190 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3191
3192 If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3193 @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3194 @end defmac
3195
3196 @defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3197 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3198 number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3199 must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3200 be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3201
3202 This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3203 general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3204 frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3205 over time.
3206 @end defmac
3207
3208 @defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3209 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3210 number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3211 only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3212 someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3213 terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3214 @end defmac
3215
3216 @hook TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC
3217 This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3218 contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3219 info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3220 @smallexample
3221 (set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3222 @end smallexample
3223 and
3224 @smallexample
3225 (set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3226 @end smallexample
3227 to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3228 the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3229 the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3230 @end deftypefn
3231
3232 @defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3233 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3234 from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3235 frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3236 the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3237 previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3238
3239 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3240 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3241 @end defmac
3242
3243 @defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3244 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3245 from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
3246 final value should coincide with that calculated by
3247 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3248 during virtual register instantiation.
3249
3250 The default value for this macro is
3251 @code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3252 which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3253 immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3254 some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3255 and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3256
3257 You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3258 want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3259 DWARF 2.
3260 @end defmac
3261
3262 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3263 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3264 in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3265 The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3266 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3267
3268 Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3269 via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3270 variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
3271 defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3272 based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3273 of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3274 should be defined.
3275 @end defmac
3276
3277 @defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3278 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3279 in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3280 in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3281 may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3282 @end defmac
3283
3284 @node Exception Handling
3285 @subsection Exception Handling Support
3286 @cindex exception handling
3287
3288 @defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3289 A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3290 data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3291 @var{N} registers are usable.
3292
3293 The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3294 handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3295 should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3296 but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
3297 2 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3298
3299 You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3300 handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3301 @end defmac
3302
3303 @defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3304 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3305 to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3306 This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3307 It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3308
3309 Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3310 untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3311
3312 Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3313 by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3314 this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3315 stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3316 this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3317 that provided by DWARF 2.
3318 @end defmac
3319
3320 @defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3321 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3322 to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3323 return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3324
3325 Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3326 return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3327 address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3328 the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3329 frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3330 been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3331 target call frame.
3332
3333 Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3334 address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3335 the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3336
3337 If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3338 define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3339 @end defmac
3340
3341 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3342 If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3343 to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3344 exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3345 using it to return to the exception handler.
3346 @end defmac
3347
3348 @defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3349 This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3350 handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3351 that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3352 and so may be read-only.
3353
3354 @var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3355 @var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3356 The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3357 as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3358
3359 If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3360 represented directly.
3361 @end defmac
3362
3363 @defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3364 This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3365 to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3366 Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3367 be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3368
3369 This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3370 handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3371 of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3372 to be emitted.
3373 @end defmac
3374
3375 @defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3376 This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3377 code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3378 available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3379 through signal frames.
3380
3381 This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3382 @file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3383 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3384 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3385 for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3386 the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3387 save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3388 evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3389 the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3390
3391 For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3392 @code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3393 @end defmac
3394
3395 @defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3396 This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3397 call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3398 usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3399
3400 This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in @file{unwind-ia64.c}.
3401 @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3402 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3403 for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3404 @code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3405 be updated in @var{fs}.
3406 @end defmac
3407
3408 @defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3409 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3410 info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3411 linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3412 @end defmac
3413
3414 @node Stack Checking
3415 @subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3416
3417 GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3418 stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3419 three ways:
3420
3421 @enumerate
3422 @item
3423 If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3424 will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3425 at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3426 other special processing.
3427
3428 @item
3429 If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3430 @code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3431 that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3432 static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3433 in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3434 stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3435 approach below.
3436
3437 @item
3438 If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3439 ``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3440 @end enumerate
3441
3442 If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3443 GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3444 @option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3445 dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3446
3447 @defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3448 A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3449 machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3450 is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3451 checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3452 value of this macro is zero.
3453 @end defmac
3454
3455 @defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3456 A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3457 in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3458 like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3459 approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
3460 @end defmac
3461
3462 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3463 An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3464 instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3465 define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3466 the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3467 of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3468 @end defmac
3469
3470 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3471 An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3472 when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3473 contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3474 thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3475 is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3476 default value of this macro is zero.
3477 @end defmac
3478
3479 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3480 The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3481 languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 75 words
3482 with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
3483 8192 bytes with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for
3484 most machines.
3485 @end defmac
3486
3487 The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3488 nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3489 in the opposite case.
3490
3491 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3492 The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3493 instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3494 stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3495 checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3496 default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3497 systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3498 @end defmac
3499
3500 @defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3501 GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3502 represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3503 space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3504 You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3505 use the default of four words.
3506 @end defmac
3507
3508 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3509 The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3510 fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3511 @option{-fstack-check}.
3512 GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3513 normally not need to override that default.
3514 @end defmac
3515
3516 @need 2000
3517 @node Frame Registers
3518 @subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3519
3520 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3521 This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3522
3523 @defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3524 The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3525 fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3526 the hardware determines which register this is.
3527 @end defmac
3528
3529 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3530 The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3531 access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3532 hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3533 choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3534 @end defmac
3535
3536 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3537 On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3538 offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3539 allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3540 between these two locations). On those machines, define
3541 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3542 be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3543 @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3544 used for the frame pointer.
3545
3546 You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3547 is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3548 the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3549 completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3550 definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3551 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3552 or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3553
3554 Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3555 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3556 @end defmac
3557
3558 @defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3559 The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3560 the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3561 frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3562 register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3563 wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3564 pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3565 @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3566 (@pxref{Elimination}).
3567 @end defmac
3568
3569 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3570 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3571 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3572 the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3573 == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3574 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3575 @end defmac
3576
3577 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3578 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3579 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3580 same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3581 ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3582 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3583 @end defmac
3584
3585 @defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3586 The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3587 access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3588 machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3589 pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3590 to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3591 @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3592
3593 Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3594 address from the stack.
3595 @end defmac
3596
3597 @defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3598 @defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3599 Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3600 register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3601 function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3602 number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3603 these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3604 not be defined.
3605
3606 The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3607
3608 If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3609 defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3610 @end defmac
3611
3612 @hook TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN
3613 This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3614 targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3615 nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3616 attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3617 those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3618
3619 The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3620
3621 If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3622 provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3623 Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3624 from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3625 will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3626 @findex stack_pointer_rtx
3627 @findex frame_pointer_rtx
3628 @findex arg_pointer_rtx
3629 The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3630 @code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3631 to refer to those items.
3632 @end deftypefn
3633
3634 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3635 This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3636 saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3637 DWARF2 exception handling.
3638
3639 Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3640 exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3641 extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3642 in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3643 used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3644 routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3645 registers that are not call-saved.
3646
3647 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3648 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3649 @end defmac
3650
3651 @defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3652
3653 This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3654 for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3655
3656 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3657 @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3658 @end defmac
3659
3660 @defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3661
3662 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3663 is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3664 Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3665 column number to use instead.
3666
3667 See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
3668 @end defmac
3669
3670 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3671
3672 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3673 used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3674 debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3675 should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3676 @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3677
3678 @end defmac
3679
3680 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3681
3682 Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3683 that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3684 should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3685 .eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
3686 return @code{@var{regno}}.
3687
3688 @end defmac
3689
3690 @node Elimination
3691 @subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3692
3693 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3694 This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3695
3696 @hook TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
3697 This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3698 a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3699 value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3700
3701 This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3702 according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3703 constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3704 to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3705 Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3706 pointer.
3707
3708 In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3709 without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3710 automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3711 @code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} returns. You don't need to worry about
3712 them.
3713
3714 In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3715 register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3716 fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3717
3718 Default return value is @code{false}.
3719 @end deftypefn
3720
3721 @findex get_frame_size
3722 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3723 A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3724 between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3725 the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3726 such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3727 registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3728
3729 If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3730 need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3731 @code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
3732 case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3733 @end defmac
3734
3735 @defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3736 If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3737 eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3738 defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3739 references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3740
3741 The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3742 of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3743
3744 On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3745 the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3746 must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3747 replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3748 depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3749
3750 In this case, you might specify:
3751 @smallexample
3752 #define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3753 @{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3754 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3755 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3756 @end smallexample
3757
3758 Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3759 specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3760 @end defmac
3761
3762 @hook TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE
3763 This target hook should returns @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3764 try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3765 @var{to_reg}. This target hook need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3766 is defined, and will usually be @code{true}, since most of the cases
3767 preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3768 knows about.
3769
3770 Default return value is @code{true}.
3771 @end deftypefn
3772
3773 @defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3774 This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3775 specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3776 registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3777 defined.
3778 @end defmac
3779
3780 @node Stack Arguments
3781 @subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3782 @cindex arguments on stack
3783 @cindex stack arguments
3784
3785 The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3786 on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3787 control passing certain arguments in registers.
3788
3789 @hook TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
3790 This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3791 prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3792 passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3793 cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3794 The default is to not promote prototypes.
3795 @end deftypefn
3796
3797 @defmac PUSH_ARGS
3798 A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3799 outgoing arguments.
3800 If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3801 That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3802 allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3803 it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3804 @end defmac
3805
3806 @defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3807 A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3808 last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3809 defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3810 and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3811 @end defmac
3812
3813 @defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3814 A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3815 stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3816
3817 On some machines, the definition
3818
3819 @smallexample
3820 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3821 @end smallexample
3822
3823 @noindent
3824 will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3825 to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3826 alignment. Then the definition should be
3827
3828 @smallexample
3829 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3830 @end smallexample
3831
3832 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
3833 @end defmac
3834
3835 @findex current_function_outgoing_args_size
3836 @defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3837 A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3838 will be computed and placed into the variable
3839 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3840 onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3841 increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3842
3843 Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3844 is not proper.
3845 @end defmac
3846
3847 @defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3848 Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3849 allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3850 registers.
3851
3852 The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3853 arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3854 which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3855 The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3856 of the function.
3857
3858 This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3859 machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3860 which.
3861 @end defmac
3862 @c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3863 @c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3864
3865 @defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3866 Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3867 caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3868 when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3869 if the function called is a library function.
3870
3871 If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3872 whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3873 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.
3874 @end defmac
3875
3876 @defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3877 Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3878 stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3879 @c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3880 @c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3881
3882 Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3883 stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3884 suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3885 stack in its natural location.
3886 @end defmac
3887
3888 @hook TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS
3889 This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3890 a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3891 and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3892
3893 @var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3894 the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3895 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3896 From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3897
3898 @var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3899 describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3900 @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3901 From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3902 arguments (if known).
3903
3904 When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3905 will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3906 you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3907 by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3908 a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3909 in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3910
3911 @var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
3912 stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3913 argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3914
3915 On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
3916 of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
3917 calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3918 the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3919 convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3920 arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3921 nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3922 @var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3923 number of arguments.
3924 @end deftypefn
3925
3926 @defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3927 A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3928 pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3929 when compiling a function call.
3930
3931 @var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3932 have been accumulated.
3933
3934 On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3935 that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3936 that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3937 call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3938 appropriate.
3939 @end defmac
3940
3941 @node Register Arguments
3942 @subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3943 @cindex arguments in registers
3944 @cindex registers arguments
3945
3946 This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3947 types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3948 the stack.
3949
3950 @hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG
3951 Return an RTX indicating whether a function argument is passed in a
3952 register and if so, which register.
3953
3954 The arguments are @var{ca}, which summarizes all the previous
3955 arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3956 the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3957 (which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
3958 which is @code{true} for an ordinary argument and @code{false} for
3959 nameless arguments that correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called
3960 function's prototype. @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a
3961 syntax error has previously occurred.
3962
3963 The return value is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3964 register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the argument
3965 on the stack.
3966
3967 The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
3968 used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
3969 @code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
3970 @code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
3971 describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
3972 @code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3973 register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
3974 register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
3975 second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
3976 the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
3977 As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
3978 RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
3979 argument is also stored on the stack.
3980
3981 The last time this hook is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
3982 VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
3983 pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
3984
3985 @cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
3986 The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a
3987 machine where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to
3988 cause nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is
3989 done by making @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever
3990 @var{named} is @code{false}.
3991
3992 @cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
3993 @cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
3994 You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
3995 in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
3996 type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
3997 is not defined and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
3998 argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
3999 defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
4000 a register.
4001 @end deftypefn
4002
4003 @hook TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK
4004 This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
4005 solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
4006 definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
4007 documentation.
4008 @end deftypefn
4009
4010 @hook TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG
4011 Define this hook if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
4012 that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
4013 necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
4014 argument.
4015
4016 For such machines, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in
4017 which the caller passes the value, and
4018 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should be defined in a similar
4019 fashion to tell the function being called where the arguments will
4020 arrive.
4021
4022 If @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined,
4023 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} serves both purposes.
4024 @end deftypefn
4025
4026 @hook TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES
4027 This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
4028 argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
4029 arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
4030 pushed on the stack.
4031
4032 On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
4033 registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
4034 first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
4035 on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
4036 structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
4037 in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
4038 compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
4039
4040 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
4041 register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
4042 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
4043 @end deftypefn
4044
4045 @hook TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE
4046 This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
4047 position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
4048 predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
4049 passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
4050
4051 If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
4052 pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
4053 The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
4054 to that type.
4055 @end deftypefn
4056
4057 @hook TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES
4058 The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4059 known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
4060 function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4061 by the caller.
4062
4063 For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
4064 determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4065 not be generated.
4066
4067 The default version of this hook always returns false.
4068 @end deftypefn
4069
4070 @defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
4071 A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument
4072 of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some
4073 target machines, the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number
4074 of bytes of argument so far.
4075
4076 There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4077 arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4078 variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4079 arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4080 @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4081 should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4082 @end defmac
4083
4084 @defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4085 If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4086 function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4087 created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4088 reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4089 If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4090 @var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4091 @end defmac
4092
4093 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4094 A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4095 @var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4096 variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4097 is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4098 the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4099 For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4100 declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4101 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4102 being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4103 arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4104 parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
4105 @var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4106
4107 When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4108 @var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4109 contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4110 an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4111 macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4112 never both of them at once.
4113 @end defmac
4114
4115 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4116 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4117 it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4118 @code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4119 is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
4120 0)} is used instead.
4121 @end defmac
4122
4123 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4124 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4125 finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4126 undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4127
4128 The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4129 with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
4130 argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4131 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4132 @c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4133 @c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
4134 @end defmac
4135
4136 @hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE
4137 This hook updates the summarizer variable pointed to by @var{ca} to
4138 advance past an argument in the argument list. The values @var{mode},
4139 @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument. Once this is done,
4140 the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing the @emph{following}
4141 argument with @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
4142
4143 This hook need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
4144 on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4145 used for arguments without any special help.
4146 @end deftypefn
4147
4148 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4149 If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4150 offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4151 which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4152 slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4153 top.
4154 @end defmac
4155
4156 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4157 If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4158 to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4159 @code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4160 @code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4161
4162 The @emph{amount} of padding is always just enough to reach the next
4163 multiple of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY}; this macro does not
4164 control it.
4165
4166 This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4167 For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4168 big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4169 constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4170 @end defmac
4171
4172 @defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4173 If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4174 implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4175 next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4176 controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4177 arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4178 @end defmac
4179
4180 @defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4181 Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4182 memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4183 macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4184 machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4185 @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4186 registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4187 a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4188 required.
4189 @end defmac
4190
4191 @hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY
4192 This hook returns the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
4193 with the specified mode and type. The default hook returns
4194 @code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4195 @end deftypefn
4196
4197 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4198 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4199 register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4200 @emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4201 the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4202 used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4203 stack.
4204 @end defmac
4205
4206 @hook TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG
4207 This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4208 as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4209 arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4210 to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4211 AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4212 registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4213 point register.
4214
4215 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4216 false.
4217 @end deftypefn
4218
4219 @hook TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST
4220 This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4221 The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4222 @end deftypefn
4223
4224 @hook TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P
4225 This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4226 to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4227 variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
4228 to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
4229 variable.
4230 The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
4231 this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4232 internal type.
4233 If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4234 Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4235 macro to iterate through all types.
4236 @end deftypefn
4237
4238 @hook TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST
4239 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4240 @var{fndecl}.
4241 The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4242 @end deftypefn
4243
4244 @hook TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE
4245 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4246 type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4247 @code{NULL_TREE}.
4248 @end deftypefn
4249
4250 @hook TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR
4251 This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4252 @code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4253 arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4254 @code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4255 @end deftypefn
4256
4257 @hook TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE
4258 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4259 with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4260 hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4261 @end deftypefn
4262
4263 @hook TARGET_REF_MAY_ALIAS_ERRNO
4264
4265 @hook TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4266 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4267 insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4268 considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4269 must work.
4270
4271 The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4272 required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4273 Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4274 code in @file{optabs.c}.
4275 @end deftypefn
4276
4277 @hook TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4278 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4279 insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4280 must have move patterns for this mode.
4281 @end deftypefn
4282
4283 @hook TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4284
4285 @hook TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P
4286 Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4287 small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4288 @var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4289 in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4290 In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4291 for any mode.
4292
4293 On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4294 insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4295 to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4296 if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4297 insn.
4298
4299 Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4300 in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4301 the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4302 classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4303 registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4304 registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4305 SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4306 strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4307 machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4308
4309 The default version of this hook returns false for any mode. It is always
4310 safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4311 unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4312 that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4313 to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4314 of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4315 @end deftypefn
4316
4317 @hook TARGET_FLAGS_REGNUM
4318
4319 @node Scalar Return
4320 @subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4321 @cindex return values in registers
4322 @cindex values, returned by functions
4323 @cindex scalars, returned as values
4324
4325 This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4326 values---values that can fit in registers.
4327
4328 @hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE
4329
4330 Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4331 returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4332 representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4333 representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4334 function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4335 compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4336 Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4337 a function returns a value.
4338
4339 On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4340 (Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4341 place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4342 @code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4343 The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
4344 multiple places. See @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
4345 @code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4346 location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4347 the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4348 that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4349 port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4350 @samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4351
4352 If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4353 the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4354 @var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4355
4356 If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4357 node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4358 pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4359 convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4360 known.
4361
4362 Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4363 which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4364 the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4365 different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4366
4367 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4368 aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
4369 @code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4370 @end deftypefn
4371
4372 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4373 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4374 a new target instead.
4375 @end defmac
4376
4377 @defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4378 A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4379 function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4380
4381 Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4382 support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4383 specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4384 compiled.
4385 @end defmac
4386
4387 @hook TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE
4388 Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
4389 function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
4390
4391 The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
4392 library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
4393 representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4394
4395 If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4396 @end deftypefn
4397
4398 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4399 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4400 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4401
4402 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4403 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4404 recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4405 suffices:
4406
4407 @smallexample
4408 #define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4409 @end smallexample
4410
4411 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4412 function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4413 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4414
4415 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4416 for a new target instead.
4417 @end defmac
4418
4419 @hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P
4420 A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4421 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4422
4423 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4424 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4425 recognized by this target hook.
4426
4427 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4428 function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4429 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4430
4431 If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4432 @end deftypefn
4433
4434 @defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4435 Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4436 need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4437 saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4438 @end defmac
4439
4440 @hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB
4441 This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4442 at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4443 padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4444 is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4445
4446 Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4447 be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4448 or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
4449 4-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4450 @code{SImode} rtx.
4451 @end deftypefn
4452
4453 @node Aggregate Return
4454 @subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4455 @cindex aggregates as return values
4456 @cindex large return values
4457 @cindex returning aggregate values
4458 @cindex structure value address
4459
4460 When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4461 cases), the value is not returned according to
4462 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4463 caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4464 should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4465 address}.
4466
4467 This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4468 memory.
4469
4470 @hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY
4471 This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4472 function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4473 Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4474 will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4475 libcalls.
4476
4477 Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4478 by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4479 takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
4480 possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4481 definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4482 values, and 0 otherwise.
4483
4484 Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4485 be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4486 to indicate this.
4487 @end deftypefn
4488
4489 @defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4490 Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4491 in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4492 only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4493 If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4494 and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4495 target hook.
4496
4497 If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4498 @end defmac
4499
4500 @hook TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX
4501 This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4502 address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4503 passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
4504 be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4505 hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4506 argument.
4507
4508 On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4509 is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4510 caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4511 be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4512 @var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4513 the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4514 the caller.
4515
4516 If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4517 stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4518 @var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4519 structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
4520 to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4521 @end deftypefn
4522
4523 @defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4524 Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4525 for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4526 the address of a static variable containing the value.
4527
4528 Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4529 pass an address to the subroutine.
4530
4531 This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4532 nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4533 @end defmac
4534
4535 @hook TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE
4536
4537 @hook TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE
4538
4539 @node Caller Saves
4540 @subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4541
4542 If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
4543 makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4544 must live across calls.
4545
4546 @defmac CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
4547 A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
4548 a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
4549 restoring it around each function call. The expression should be 1 when
4550 this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
4551
4552 If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
4553 machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
4554 @end defmac
4555
4556 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4557 A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4558 of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4559 @var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4560 returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4561 will select the smallest suitable mode.
4562 @end defmac
4563
4564 @node Function Entry
4565 @subsection Function Entry and Exit
4566 @cindex function entry and exit
4567 @cindex prologue
4568 @cindex epilogue
4569
4570 This section describes the macros that output function entry
4571 (@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4572
4573 @hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE
4574 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4575 function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4576 initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4577 saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4578 local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4579 stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4580
4581 The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4582 macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4583
4584 @findex regs_ever_live
4585 To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4586 @code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4587 @var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4588 prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4589 call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4590 @code{regs_ever_live}.)
4591
4592 On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4593 not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4594 they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4595 appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4596 registers are used in the function.
4597
4598 @findex frame_pointer_needed
4599 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4600 function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4601 pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4602 frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4603 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4604 time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4605
4606 The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4607 required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4608 listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4609 order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4610 stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4611 the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4612 for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4613 compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4614 or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4615 need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4616 @end deftypefn
4617
4618 @hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE
4619 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4620 prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4621 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4622 emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4623 @end deftypefn
4624
4625 @hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE
4626 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4627 epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4628 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4629 emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4630 @end deftypefn
4631
4632 @hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE
4633 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4634 function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4635 registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4636 called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4637 same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4638 registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4639 @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4640
4641 On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4642 of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4643 instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4644 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4645
4646 Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4647 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4648 switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4649 define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4650 target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4651 condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4652
4653 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4654 function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4655 two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4656 is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4657 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4658 a function that needs a frame pointer.
4659
4660 Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4661 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4662 The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4663 function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4664
4665 On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4666 others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4667 given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4668 number of arguments.
4669
4670 @findex current_function_pops_args
4671 Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4672 functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4673 needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4674 function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4675 @code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4676 @end deftypefn
4677
4678 @itemize @bullet
4679 @item
4680 @findex current_function_pretend_args_size
4681 A region of @code{current_function_pretend_args_size} bytes of
4682 uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4683 stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4684 if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4685 arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4686 yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4687 region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4688 registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4689 features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4690
4691 @item
4692 An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4693 The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4694 the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4695 machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4696 in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4697 a save area.
4698
4699 @item
4700 A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4701 boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4702 this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4703 save area closer to the top of the stack.
4704
4705 @item
4706 @cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4707 Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4708 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4709 argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4710 @end itemize
4711
4712 @defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4713 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4714 instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4715 pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4716 adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4717 default is 0.
4718
4719 Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4720 frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4721 stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4722 compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4723 @end defmac
4724
4725 @defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4726 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4727 used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4728 pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4729 @end defmac
4730
4731 @defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4732 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4733 used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4734 on entry to an exception edge.
4735 @end defmac
4736
4737 @defmac DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
4738 Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
4739 instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''. The
4740 definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
4741 representing the number of delay slots there.
4742 @end defmac
4743
4744 @defmac ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
4745 A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
4746 slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
4747
4748 The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
4749 being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
4750 eligibility). It is never negative and is always less than the number
4751 of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
4752 If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
4753 may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot. Also, other insns may
4754 (at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
4755 slot.
4756
4757 @findex current_function_epilogue_delay_list
4758 @findex final_scan_insn
4759 The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
4760 list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in the variable
4761 @code{current_function_epilogue_delay_list}. The insn for the first
4762 delay slot comes first in the list. Your definition of the macro
4763 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by
4764 outputting the insns in this list, usually by calling
4765 @code{final_scan_insn}.
4766
4767 You need not define this macro if you did not define
4768 @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
4769 @end defmac
4770
4771 @hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4772 A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4773 function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4774 inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4775 adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4776 the real function.
4777
4778 First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4779 contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4780 contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4781 in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4782 e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4783 all other incoming arguments.
4784
4785 Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4786 made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4787 adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4788
4789 @smallexample
4790 p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4791 @end smallexample
4792
4793 After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4794 @code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4795 not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4796 return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4797
4798 The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4799 the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4800 of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4801 and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4802
4803 The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4804 have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4805 some targets, but probably not.
4806
4807 If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4808 front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4809 @var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4810 not support varargs.
4811 @end deftypefn
4812
4813 @hook TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4814 A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4815 to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4816 arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4817 generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4818 previously exposed.
4819 @end deftypefn
4820
4821 @node Profiling
4822 @subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4823 @cindex profiling, code generation
4824
4825 These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4826
4827 @defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4828 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4829 assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4830
4831 @findex mcount
4832 The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4833 your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4834 compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4835 compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4836
4837 Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4838 variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4839 @samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4840 the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4841 @end defmac
4842
4843 @defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4844 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4845 code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4846 not support profiling.
4847 @end defmac
4848
4849 @defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4850 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4851 @code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4852 allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4853 implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4854 @var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4855 @end defmac
4856
4857 @defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4858 Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4859 the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4860 @end defmac
4861
4862 @node Tail Calls
4863 @subsection Permitting tail calls
4864 @cindex tail calls
4865
4866 @hook TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL
4867 True if it is ok to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4868 call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4869 or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4870
4871 It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4872 tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4873 during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4874 as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4875 ``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4876 may vary greatly between different architectures.
4877 @end deftypefn
4878
4879 @hook TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY
4880 Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4881 function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4882 cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4883 registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4884 TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4885 FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4886 @end deftypefn
4887
4888 @node Stack Smashing Protection
4889 @subsection Stack smashing protection
4890 @cindex stack smashing protection
4891
4892 @hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD
4893 This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
4894 for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
4895 runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4896 that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
4897 variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4898
4899 The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4900 @samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4901 @end deftypefn
4902
4903 @hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL
4904 This hook returns a tree expression that alerts the runtime that the
4905 stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
4906 involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
4907
4908 The default version of this hook invokes a function called
4909 @samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
4910 normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4911 @end deftypefn
4912
4913 @hook TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK
4914
4915 @node Varargs
4916 @section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4917 @cindex varargs implementation
4918
4919 GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4920 @code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
4921 on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
4922 varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4923 conditionals to include it.
4924
4925 ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
4926 the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
4927 implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
4928 to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
4929 @code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
4930 supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4931
4932 However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
4933 the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
4934 below.
4935
4936 @defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
4937 Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
4938 that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
4939 versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
4940 you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
4941
4942 On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
4943 control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
4944 other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
4945 found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4946
4947 Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
4948 beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
4949 @code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
4950 This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
4951 to use them for its own purposes.
4952 @c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
4953 @c 10feb93
4954 @end defmac
4955
4956 @defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
4957 This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
4958 argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
4959 returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
4960 argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
4961 fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
4962 verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
4963 of the current function.
4964 @end defmac
4965
4966 @defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
4967 Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
4968 passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
4969 has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
4970 specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
4971 with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
4972
4973 @code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
4974 considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
4975 kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
4976
4977 The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
4978 interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
4979 @end defmac
4980
4981 These machine description macros help implement varargs:
4982
4983 @hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS
4984 If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
4985 @code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
4986 beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
4987 return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
4988 to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
4989 @end deftypefn
4990
4991 @hook TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
4992 This target hook offers an alternative to using
4993 @code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
4994 @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
4995 register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
4996 have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
4997 use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
4998 pass all their arguments on the stack.
4999
5000 The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
5001 structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
5002 named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
5003 last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
5004
5005 The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
5006 argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
5007 store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
5008 variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
5009 store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
5010 frame.
5011
5012 Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5013 compile time without knowing their data types,
5014 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5015 have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5016 for all data types.
5017
5018 If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5019 arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5020 happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5021 end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5022 not generate any instructions in this case.
5023 @end deftypefn
5024
5025 @hook TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
5026 Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5027 argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5028
5029 This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
5030 is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5031 @code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5032 arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5033 but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5034 then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5035 except the last are treated as named.
5036
5037 You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5038 @end deftypefn
5039
5040 @hook TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
5041 If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5042 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5043 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5044 defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5045 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5046 Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5047 @end deftypefn
5048
5049 @node Trampolines
5050 @section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5051 @cindex trampolines for nested functions
5052 @cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5053
5054 A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5055 when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5056 the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
5057 tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
5058 trampoline.
5059
5060 The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5061 address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5062 the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5063 two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5064 exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5065 machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5066 two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5067 operands.
5068
5069 The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5070 parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5071 immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5072 simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5073 proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5074 may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5075 separately.
5076
5077 @hook TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE
5078 This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5079 on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5080 the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5081 label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5082
5083 If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5084 for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5085 code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5086 to generate it on the spot.
5087 @end deftypefn
5088
5089 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5090 Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5091 (@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5092 @end defmac
5093
5094 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5095 A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5096 @end defmac
5097
5098 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5099 Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5100
5101 If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5102 is used for aligning trampolines.
5103 @end defmac
5104
5105 @hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT
5106 This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5107 @var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5108 is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5109 RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5110 when it is called.
5111
5112 If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5113 first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5114 from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
5115 Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
5116 trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5117 to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5118
5119 If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
5120 enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
5121 initializing the trampoline proper.
5122 @end deftypefn
5123
5124 @hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS
5125 This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5126 the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5127 memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5128 the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5129 address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5130 be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5131 If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5132 @end deftypefn
5133
5134 Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5135 separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5136 fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5137 jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5138
5139 Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5140 the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5141 make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5142 subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5143 latter makes initialization faster.
5144
5145 To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5146 the following macro.
5147
5148 @defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5149 If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5150 cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5151 typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5152 @var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5153 @end defmac
5154
5155 To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5156 you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5157 cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5158 beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5159 its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5160
5161 @defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5162 Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5163 work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5164 which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
5165 @code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5166
5167 If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5168 C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5169 special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5170 statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5171 global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5172 special assembler code.
5173 @end defmac
5174
5175 @node Library Calls
5176 @section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5177 @cindex library subroutine names
5178 @cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5179
5180 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5181 Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5182
5183 @defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5184 This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5185 expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
5186 provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5187 are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5188 @end defmac
5189
5190 @findex set_optab_libfunc
5191 @findex init_one_libfunc
5192 @hook TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS
5193 This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5194 existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5195 @code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5196 @code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5197 library routines.
5198
5199 The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5200 @end deftypefn
5201
5202 @hook TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX
5203
5204 @defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5205 This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5206 implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5207 mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5208 return a tristate.
5209
5210 GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5211 comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5212 don't need to define this macro.
5213 @end defmac
5214
5215 @defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5216 This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5217 functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5218 operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5219 and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5220 If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5221 @minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
5222 in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5223 @end defmac
5224
5225 @cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5226 @findex matherr
5227 @defmac TARGET_EDOM
5228 The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5229 expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5230 deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5231 @file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5232 system.
5233
5234 If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5235 domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5236 error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5237 there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5238 that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5239 @end defmac
5240
5241 @cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5242 @defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5243 Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5244 refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5245 @code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5246 macro, a reasonable default is used.
5247 @end defmac
5248
5249 @cindex C99 math functions, implicit usage
5250 @defmac TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
5251 When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize @code{sin} calls into
5252 @code{sinf} and similarly for other functions defined by C99 standard. The
5253 default is zero because a number of existing systems lack support for these
5254 functions in their runtime so this macro needs to be redefined to one on
5255 systems that do support the C99 runtime.
5256 @end defmac
5257
5258 @cindex sincos math function, implicit usage
5259 @defmac TARGET_HAS_SINCOS
5260 When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize calls to @code{sin}
5261 and @code{cos} with the same argument to a call to @code{sincos}. The
5262 default is zero. The target has to provide the following functions:
5263 @smallexample
5264 void sincos(double x, double *sin, double *cos);
5265 void sincosf(float x, float *sin, float *cos);
5266 void sincosl(long double x, long double *sin, long double *cos);
5267 @end smallexample
5268 @end defmac
5269
5270 @defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
5271 Define this macro to generate code for Objective-C message sending using
5272 the calling convention of the NeXT system. This calling convention
5273 involves passing the object, the selector and the method arguments all
5274 at once to the method-lookup library function.
5275
5276 The default calling convention passes just the object and the selector
5277 to the lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5278 @end defmac
5279
5280 @node Addressing Modes
5281 @section Addressing Modes
5282 @cindex addressing modes
5283
5284 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5285 This is about addressing modes.
5286
5287 @defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5288 @defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5289 @defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5290 @defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5291 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5292 pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5293 @end defmac
5294
5295 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5296 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5297 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5298 post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5299 the size of the memory operand.
5300 @end defmac
5301
5302 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5303 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5304 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5305 post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5306 @end defmac
5307
5308 @defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5309 A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5310 is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5311 @code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5312 is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
5313 constant addresses are supported.
5314 @end defmac
5315
5316 @defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5317 @code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5318 accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5319 known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5320 expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5321 @code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5322 @end defmac
5323
5324 @defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5325 A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5326 memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5327 the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5328 accept.
5329 @end defmac
5330
5331 @hook TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
5332 A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5333 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5334
5335 Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5336 non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5337 desired by the caller.
5338
5339 The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5340 that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5341 considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5342 kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5343 must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5344 up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5345 register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5346 if the array holds @code{-1}.
5347
5348 The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5349 accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5350 register is required.
5351
5352 Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5353 and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5354 constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5355 specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5356 recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5357
5358 Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5359 sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5360 @code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5361 naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5362 be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5363
5364 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5365 On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5366 the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
5367 target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5368 into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
5369 @code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5370 @code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5371 Format}.
5372
5373 @cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5374 Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5375 this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5376 has this syntax:
5377
5378 @example
5379 #define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5380 @end example
5381
5382 @noindent
5383 and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5384 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5385
5386 @findex REG_OK_STRICT
5387 Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5388 macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
5389 @code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5390 that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5391
5392 Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5393 files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5394 @end deftypefn
5395
5396 @defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5397 A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5398 character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5399 letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5400 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
5401 support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5402 semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5403 preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5404 @code{'m'} constraint.
5405 @end defmac
5406
5407 @defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5408 A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5409 or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5410 can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5411 @code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5412
5413 It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5414 that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5415
5416 The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5417 a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5418 @end defmac
5419
5420 @hook TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5421 This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5422 operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5423 address.
5424
5425 @findex break_out_memory_refs
5426 @var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5427 and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5428 @var{x}.
5429
5430 The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5431 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5432 should return the new @var{x}.
5433
5434 It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address.
5435 The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, it
5436 is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5437 a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5438 strategy can generate better code.
5439 @end deftypefn
5440
5441 @defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5442 A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5443 that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5444 @var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5445 It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5446 performance reasons.
5447
5448 For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5449 reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5450 registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5451 processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5452 needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5453 @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5454 generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5455 be shared.
5456
5457 @emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5458 to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5459 and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5460 of reload internals.
5461
5462 @emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5463 previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5464 then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5465
5466 @findex push_reload
5467 The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5468 need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5469 suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5470
5471 The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5472 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5473 should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5474 This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5475 @code{push_reload}.
5476
5477 @findex strict_memory_address_p
5478 The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5479 the address has become legitimate.
5480
5481 @findex copy_rtx
5482 If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5483 this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
5484 single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5485 top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5486 It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5487 address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5488 @end defmac
5489
5490 @hook TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P
5491 This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} can have
5492 different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5493 reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5494 but not others.
5495
5496 Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5497 effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5498 of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5499 addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5500
5501 You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5502
5503 The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5504 @end deftypefn
5505
5506 @defmac GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS (@var{addr}, @var{label})
5507 A C statement or compound statement with a conditional @code{goto
5508 @var{label};} executed if memory address @var{x} (an RTX) can have
5509 different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5510 reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5511 but not others.
5512
5513 Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5514 effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5515 of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5516 addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5517
5518 You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5519
5520 These are obsolete macros, replaced by the
5521 @code{TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P} target hook.
5522 @end defmac
5523
5524 @hook TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P
5525 This hook returns true if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for a
5526 @var{mode}-mode immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5527 @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.
5528
5529 The default definition returns true.
5530 @end deftypefn
5531
5532 @hook TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5533 This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5534 @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5535 macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5536 references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5537 addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5538 the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5539 into their original form.
5540 @end deftypefn
5541
5542 @hook TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM
5543 This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
5544 should not) be spilled to the constant pool. @var{mode} is the mode
5545 of @var{x}.
5546
5547 The default version of this hook returns false.
5548
5549 The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5550 deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5551 from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5552 holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5553 of TLS symbols for various targets.
5554 @end deftypefn
5555
5556 @hook TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P
5557 This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5558 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5559 of @var{x}.
5560
5561 The default version returns false for all constants.
5562 @end deftypefn
5563
5564 @hook TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL
5565 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements reciprocal of
5566 the builtin function with builtin function code @var{fn}, or
5567 @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available. @var{md_fn} is true
5568 when @var{fn} is a code of a machine-dependent builtin function. When
5569 @var{sqrt} is true, additional optimizations that apply only to the reciprocal
5570 of a square root function are performed, and only reciprocals of @code{sqrt}
5571 function are valid.
5572 @end deftypefn
5573
5574 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD
5575 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5576 address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5577 used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5578 @var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5579
5580 The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5581 @var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5582 the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5583 @code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5584 two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5585 @var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5586 the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5587 from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5588 @var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5589 @var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5590 @var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5591
5592 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5593 to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5594 use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5595 @code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5596 should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5597 described above.
5598 If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5599 the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5600 log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5601 @end deftypefn
5602
5603 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN
5604 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5605 widening multiplication of the even elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5606
5607 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5608 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD} target hook when vectorizing
5609 widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5610 preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5611 @code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5612 @end deftypefn
5613
5614 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD
5615 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5616 widening multiplication of the odd elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5617
5618 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5619 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN} target hook when vectorizing
5620 widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5621 preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5622 @code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5623 @end deftypefn
5624
5625 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST
5626 Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
5627 For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
5628 misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
5629 @end deftypefn
5630
5631 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE
5632 Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5633 @end deftypefn
5634
5635 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VEC_PERM
5636 Target builtin that implements vector permute.
5637 @end deftypefn
5638
5639 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VEC_PERM_OK
5640 Return true if a vector created for @code{builtin_vec_perm} is valid.
5641 @end deftypefn
5642
5643 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION
5644 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
5645 input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
5646 The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5647 specifies how the conversion is to be applied
5648 (truncation, rounding, etc.).
5649
5650 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5651 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5652 conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5653 @end deftypefn
5654
5655 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION
5656 This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5657 vectorized variant of the builtin function with builtin function code
5658 @var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5659 The value of @var{fndecl} is the builtin function declaration. The
5660 return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5661 @var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5662 @end deftypefn
5663
5664 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT
5665 This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5666 store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5667 parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5668 the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5669 parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5670 @end deftypefn
5671
5672 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE
5673 This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5674 mode @var{mode}. The default is
5675 equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
5676 transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5677 @end deftypefn
5678
5679 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES
5680 This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5681 after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5682 mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5683 The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5684 @end deftypefn
5685
5686 @node Anchored Addresses
5687 @section Anchored Addresses
5688 @cindex anchored addresses
5689 @cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5690
5691 GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5692 For example, if we have:
5693
5694 @smallexample
5695 static int a, b, c;
5696 int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5697 @end smallexample
5698
5699 the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5700 addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5701 it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5702 the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5703 be something like:
5704
5705 @smallexample
5706 int foo (void)
5707 @{
5708 register int *xr = &x;
5709 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5710 @}
5711 @end smallexample
5712
5713 (which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5714 ``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5715
5716 The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5717 in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5718 section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5719 or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5720
5721 @hook TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5722 The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5723 On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5724 applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5725 for every mode. The default value is 0.
5726 @end deftypevr
5727
5728 @hook TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5729 Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5730 offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5731 value is 0.
5732 @end deftypevr
5733
5734 @hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR
5735 Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5736 @code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5737 The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5738 of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5739
5740 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5741 it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5742 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5743 is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5744 @end deftypefn
5745
5746 @hook TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P
5747 Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
5748 @var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
5749 @samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5750
5751 The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5752 intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5753 or target-specific sections.
5754 @end deftypefn
5755
5756 @node Condition Code
5757 @section Condition Code Status
5758 @cindex condition code status
5759
5760 The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5761 two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5762
5763 The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5764 (@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5765 clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5766 register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5767 architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5768 most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5769 most RISC machines.
5770
5771 The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
5772 the definition and use of the condition code, which need to be in adjacent
5773 insns for machines using @code{(cc0)}. This can prevent important
5774 optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5775 is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5776 three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
5777 scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5778 separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5779
5780 For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5781 represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
5782 condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
5783 condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5784 or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5785 Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5786 that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
5787
5788 Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
5789 specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
5790 interested in most macros in this section.
5791
5792 @menu
5793 * CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
5794 * MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
5795 * Cond Exec Macros:: Macros to control conditional execution.
5796 @end menu
5797
5798 @node CC0 Condition Codes
5799 @subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
5800 @findex cc0
5801
5802 @findex cc_status
5803 The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5804 describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5805 the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5806 variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5807 currently based, and several standard flags.
5808
5809 Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5810 description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5811 information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5812
5813 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
5814 C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5815 component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5816
5817 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5818 @end defmac
5819
5820 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5821 A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5822 The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5823 the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5824 define this macro to initialize it.
5825
5826 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5827 @end defmac
5828
5829 @defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
5830 A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5831 appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5832 this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5833 code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5834 set @code{(cc0)}.
5835
5836 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5837
5838 If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5839 other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5840 invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5841 reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5842 registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5843 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5844 insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5845 based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5846 value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5847 this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5848 @samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5849 @code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5850 condition code value.
5851
5852 The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5853 with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5854 @code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5855 constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5856 insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5857 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5858 @code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5859
5860 A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5861 that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5862 @samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5863 two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
5864 @end defmac
5865
5866 @node MODE_CC Condition Codes
5867 @subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
5868 @findex CCmode
5869 @findex MODE_CC
5870
5871 @defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
5872 On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
5873 than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
5874 code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
5875 when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
5876 bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
5877 branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
5878 this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
5879 record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
5880 also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
5881 unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
5882
5883 If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
5884 @file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
5885 a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
5886 have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
5887 by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
5888 be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
5889 the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
5890
5891 @smallexample
5892 (define_insn ""
5893 [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
5894 (compare:CC_NOOV
5895 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
5896 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
5897 (const_int 0)))]
5898 ""
5899 "@dots{}")
5900 @end smallexample
5901
5902 @noindent
5903 together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
5904 for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
5905
5906 @smallexample
5907 #define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
5908 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
5909 ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode) \
5910 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
5911 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
5912 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
5913 @end smallexample
5914
5915 Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
5916 were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
5917 this section.
5918
5919 You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
5920 in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
5921 @end defmac
5922
5923 @defmac CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
5924 On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
5925 convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
5926 does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
5927 comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
5928
5929 On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
5930 required conversions. @var{code} is the initial comparison code
5931 and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
5932 comparison, respectively. You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
5933 @var{op1} as required.
5934
5935 GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
5936 valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
5937 @file{md} file.
5938
5939 You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
5940 code or operands.
5941 @end defmac
5942
5943 @defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
5944 A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
5945 comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
5946 can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
5947 then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
5948
5949 You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
5950 floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
5951 For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
5952 inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
5953
5954 @smallexample
5955 #define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
5956 @end smallexample
5957 @end defmac
5958
5959 @defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
5960 A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
5961 comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
5962 @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
5963 machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
5964 instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
5965 freely convert unordered compares to ordered one. Then definition may look
5966 like:
5967
5968 @smallexample
5969 #define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
5970 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
5971 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
5972 @end smallexample
5973 @end defmac
5974
5975 @hook TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS
5976 On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
5977 register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
5978 regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
5979 hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
5980 small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
5981 to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
5982 arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
5983 When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
5984 integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
5985 @code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
5986
5987 The default version of this hook returns false.
5988 @end deftypefn
5989
5990 @hook TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE
5991 On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
5992 @code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
5993 validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
5994 target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
5995 both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
5996 return @code{VOIDmode}.
5997
5998 The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
5999 same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6000 returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6001 @end deftypefn
6002
6003 @node Cond Exec Macros
6004 @subsection Macros to control conditional execution
6005 @findex conditional execution
6006 @findex predication
6007
6008 There is one macro that may need to be defined for targets
6009 supporting conditional execution, independent of how they
6010 represent conditional branches.
6011
6012 @defmac REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (@var{op1}, @var{op2})
6013 A C expression that returns true if the conditional execution predicate
6014 @var{op1}, a comparison operation, is the inverse of @var{op2} and vice
6015 versa. Define this to return 0 if the target has conditional execution
6016 predicates that cannot be reversed safely. There is no need to validate
6017 that the arguments of op1 and op2 are the same, this is done separately.
6018 If no expansion is specified, this macro is defined as follows:
6019
6020 @smallexample
6021 #define REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (x, y) \
6022 (GET_CODE ((x)) == reversed_comparison_code ((y), NULL))
6023 @end smallexample
6024 @end defmac
6025
6026 @node Costs
6027 @section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6028 @cindex costs of instructions
6029 @cindex relative costs
6030 @cindex speed of instructions
6031
6032 These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6033 on the target machine.
6034
6035 @defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6036 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6037 register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6038 expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6039 value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6040 that.
6041
6042 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6043 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6044 registers if they are not general registers.
6045
6046 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6047 hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6048 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6049 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6050 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6051 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6052
6053 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6054 @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6055 @end defmac
6056
6057 @hook TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST
6058 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6059 from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6060 are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6061 A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6062 that.
6063
6064 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6065 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6066 registers if they are not general registers.
6067
6068 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6069 hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6070 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6071 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6072 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6073 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6074
6075 The default version of this function returns 2.
6076 @end deftypefn
6077
6078 @defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6079 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6080 register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6081 is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
6082 is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6083 registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6084 should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6085
6086 If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6087 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6088 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6089 between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6090 more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6091 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6092
6093 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6094 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6095 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6096 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6097 4 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6098 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6099 are the same as to this macro.
6100
6101 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6102 @code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6103 @end defmac
6104
6105 @hook TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST
6106 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6107 between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
6108 if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6109 This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6110 If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6111 registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6112
6113 If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6114 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6115 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6116 between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
6117 more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6118 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6119
6120 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6121 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6122 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6123 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6124 4 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6125 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6126 are the same as to this target hook.
6127 @end deftypefn
6128
6129 @defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
6130 A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
6131 the default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter
6132 @var{speed_p} is true when the branch in question should be optimized
6133 for speed. When it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should return a value
6134 optimal for code size rather than performance. @var{predictable_p} is
6135 true for well-predicted branches. On many architectures the
6136 @code{BRANCH_COST} can be reduced then.
6137 @end defmac
6138
6139 Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6140 but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6141 ordinarily expect.
6142
6143 @defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6144 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6145 than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6146 faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6147 require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6148 between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6149
6150 When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6151 finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6152 load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6153 faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6154 may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6155 other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6156 @end defmac
6157
6158 @defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
6159 Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6160 @var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6161 than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6162 handler.
6163
6164 When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6165 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
6166 moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6167 Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
6168 cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6169
6170 If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
6171 this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6172 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
6173 @end defmac
6174
6175 @defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6176 The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6177 which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6178 string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6179 make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6180
6181 Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6182 @code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6183 the number of such sequences.
6184
6185 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6186 optimized for speed rather than size.
6187
6188 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6189 @end defmac
6190
6191 @defmac MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6192 A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
6193 copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
6194 will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6195 than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6196 @end defmac
6197
6198 @defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6199 A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6200 a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6201 @end defmac
6202
6203 @defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6204 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6205 of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6206 or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6207 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6208
6209 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6210 optimized for speed rather than size.
6211
6212 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6213 @end defmac
6214
6215 @defmac CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6216 A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
6217 to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
6218 will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6219 than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
6220 @end defmac
6221
6222 @defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6223 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6224 of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
6225 a block set insn or a library call.
6226 Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6227 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6228
6229 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6230 optimized for speed rather than size.
6231
6232 If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6233 @end defmac
6234
6235 @defmac SET_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6236 A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6237 used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some
6238 other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when
6239 storing values other than constant zero.
6240 Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6241 than @code{SET_RATIO}.
6242 @end defmac
6243
6244 @defmac STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6245 A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6246 used to set a chunk of memory to a constant string value, or whether some
6247 other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
6248 called with a constant source string.
6249 Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6250 than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6251 @end defmac
6252
6253 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6254 A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6255 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6256 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6257 @end defmac
6258
6259 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6260 A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6261 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6262 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6263 @end defmac
6264
6265 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6266 A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6267 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6268 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6269 @end defmac
6270
6271 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6272 A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6273 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6274 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6275 @end defmac
6276
6277 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6278 A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6279 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6280 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6281 @end defmac
6282
6283 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6284 A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6285 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6286 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6287 @end defmac
6288
6289 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6290 This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6291 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6292 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6293 @end defmac
6294
6295 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6296 This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6297 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6298 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6299 @end defmac
6300
6301 @defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6302 Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
6303 function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6304 @end defmac
6305
6306 @defmac RANGE_TEST_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6307 Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6308 @samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6309 @code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6310 @end defmac
6311
6312 @hook TARGET_RTX_COSTS
6313 This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6314
6315 The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
6316 available for examination in @var{x}, and the rtx code of the expression
6317 in which it is contained, found in @var{outer_code}. @var{code} is the
6318 expression code---redundant, since it can be obtained with
6319 @code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
6320
6321 In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6322 @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6323 instructions.
6324
6325 On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6326 for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
6327 necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6328 for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6329 operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6330
6331 When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6332 false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6333 size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6334
6335 The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6336 processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6337 @end deftypefn
6338
6339 @hook TARGET_ADDRESS_COST
6340 This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6341 @var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6342 the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6343
6344 For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6345 true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6346 instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6347 all addresses will have equal costs.
6348
6349 In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6350 the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6351 cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6352
6353 For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6354 and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6355 is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6356 references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6357 the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6358 that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6359 instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6360 specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6361
6362 This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6363
6364 On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6365 cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6366 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6367 be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6368 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6369 should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6370 should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6371 registers on machines with lots of registers.
6372 @end deftypefn
6373
6374 @node Scheduling
6375 @section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6376
6377 The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6378 adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6379 hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6380 them: try the first ones in this list first.
6381
6382 @hook TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE
6383 This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6384 issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6385 Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6386 an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6387 constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6388 hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6389 This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6390 it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
6391 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6392 @end deftypefn
6393
6394 @hook TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE
6395 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6396 from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
6397 still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6398 @samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6399 @code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6400 You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6401 than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6402 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6403 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6404 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6405 was scheduled.
6406 @end deftypefn
6407
6408 @hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST
6409 This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6410 relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
6411 dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
6412 is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
6413 to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
6414 that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
6415 data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6416 description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6417 output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6418 times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6419 acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
6420 @pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
6421 @end deftypefn
6422
6423 @hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY
6424 This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6425 @var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6426 execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
6427 later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6428 scheduling priorities of insns.
6429 @end deftypefn
6430
6431 @hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER
6432 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6433 list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6434 combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6435 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6436 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6437 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6438 list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6439 a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6440 reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
6441 @var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
6442 is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6443 the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6444 can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6445 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6446 @end deftypefn
6447
6448 @hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2
6449 Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6450 function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6451 is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6452 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6453 return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6454 this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6455 scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6456 cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6457 @end deftypefn
6458
6459 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK
6460 This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6461 chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6462 correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6463 example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6464 analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6465 dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6466 calculated.
6467 @end deftypefn
6468
6469 @hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT
6470 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6471 instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6472 pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6473 is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6474 @var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6475 region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
6476 scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
6477 @end deftypefn
6478
6479 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH
6480 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6481 instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6482 cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6483 is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6484 to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6485 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6486 @end deftypefn
6487
6488 @hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL
6489 This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6490 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6491 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6492 @var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6493 @end deftypefn
6494
6495 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL
6496 This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
6497 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6498 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6499 @end deftypefn
6500
6501 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
6502 The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6503 pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6504 when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6505 simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6506 processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6507 based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6508 when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6509 @end deftypefn
6510
6511 @hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
6512 The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6513 @end deftypefn
6514
6515 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
6516 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6517 to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6518 simulated processor cycle finishes.
6519 @end deftypefn
6520
6521 @hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
6522 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6523 used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6524 @end deftypefn
6525
6526 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE
6527 The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6528 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6529 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6530 state on a single insn is not enough.
6531 @end deftypefn
6532
6533 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE
6534 The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6535 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6536 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6537 state on a single insn is not enough.
6538 @end deftypefn
6539
6540 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD
6541 This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6542 for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6543 chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6544 value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6545 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6546 subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6547 maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6548 @acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6549 packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6550 rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6551
6552 This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6553 processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6554 with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6555 @var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6556 @var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6557 processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6558 @var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6559 until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6560 the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6561
6562 Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6563 pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6564 schedules to choose the best one.
6565
6566 The default is no multipass scheduling.
6567 @end deftypefn
6568
6569 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD
6570
6571 This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6572 considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
6573 zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be not chosen to
6574 be issued.
6575
6576 The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
6577 @end deftypefn
6578
6579 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN
6580 This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
6581 scheduling.
6582 @end deftypefn
6583
6584 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE
6585 This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
6586 @end deftypefn
6587
6588 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK
6589 This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
6590 an instruction.
6591 @end deftypefn
6592
6593 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END
6594 This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
6595 round of multipass scheduling.
6596 @end deftypefn
6597
6598 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT
6599 This hook initializes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6600 @end deftypefn
6601
6602 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI
6603 This hook finalizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6604 @end deftypefn
6605
6606 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE
6607 This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6608 on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6609 @var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6610 the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6611 is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6612 start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6613 verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6614 @var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6615 processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6616 and the current processor cycle.
6617 @end deftypefn
6618
6619 @hook TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE
6620 This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
6621 the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
6622 are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
6623 to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6624 being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
6625 dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
6626 parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
6627 The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6628 insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6629 and @code{false} otherwise.
6630
6631 Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
6632 where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
6633 delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
6634 that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
6635 important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
6636 closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
6637 not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
6638 @end deftypefn
6639
6640 @hook TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED
6641 This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6642 the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6643 per instruction data structures.
6644 @end deftypefn
6645
6646 @hook TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT
6647 Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6648 @end deftypefn
6649
6650 @hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT
6651 Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6652 It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
6653 beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
6654 @end deftypefn
6655
6656 @hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT
6657 Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
6658 @end deftypefn
6659
6660 @hook TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT
6661 Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6662 @end deftypefn
6663
6664 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT
6665 Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6666 @end deftypefn
6667
6668 @hook TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN
6669 This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6670 speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6671 The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6672 version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6673 pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
6674 or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
6675 speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6676 the generated speculative pattern.
6677 @end deftypefn
6678
6679 @hook TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P
6680 This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
6681 for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6682 instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
6683 @end deftypefn
6684
6685 @hook TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK
6686 This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
6687 check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6688 speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6689 @var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6690 be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6691 recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6692 a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
6693 @var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6694 @end deftypefn
6695
6696 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD_SPEC
6697 This hook is used as a workaround for
6698 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD} not being
6699 called on the first instruction of the ready list. The hook is used to
6700 discard speculative instructions that stand first in the ready list from
6701 being scheduled on the current cycle. If the hook returns @code{false},
6702 @var{insn} will not be chosen to be issued.
6703 For non-speculative instructions,
6704 the hook should always return @code{true}. For example, in the ia64 backend
6705 the hook is used to cancel data speculative insns when the ALAT table
6706 is nearly full.
6707 @end deftypefn
6708
6709 @hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS
6710 This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
6711 enabled/used.
6712 The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
6713 The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6714 @end deftypefn
6715
6716 @hook TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII
6717 This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6718 resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6719 the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
6720 backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
6721 bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6722 of instructions divided by the issue rate.
6723 @end deftypefn
6724
6725 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH
6726 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
6727 is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
6728 @end deftypefn
6729
6730 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO
6731 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
6732 in its second parameter.
6733 @end deftypefn
6734
6735 @hook TARGET_SCHED_EXPOSED_PIPELINE
6736
6737 @node Sections
6738 @section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6739 @c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
6740 @c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
6741
6742 An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6743 data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
6744 section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
6745 section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
6746 section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
6747 of sections.
6748
6749 @file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
6750 @code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
6751 The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
6752 is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
6753 as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
6754 initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
6755 They may however depend on command-line flags.
6756
6757 @emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
6758 use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
6759 to be string literals.
6760
6761 Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
6762 section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
6763 should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
6764 @code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
6765
6766 You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
6767 @code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
6768 in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
6769 @code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
6770 create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
6771 reuse @code{text_section}.
6772
6773 All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
6774 if the target does not provide them.
6775
6776 @defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6777 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6778 assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
6779 Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
6780 @end defmac
6781
6782 @defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6783 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
6784 frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
6785 a default definition if the target supports named sections.
6786 @end defmac
6787
6788 @defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6789 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
6790 executed functions in the program.
6791 @end defmac
6792
6793 @defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6794 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6795 assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
6796 data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
6797 @end defmac
6798
6799 @defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6800 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6801 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6802 initialized, writable small data.
6803 @end defmac
6804
6805 @defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6806 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6807 assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
6808 data.
6809 @end defmac
6810
6811 @defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6812 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6813 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6814 uninitialized global data. If not defined, and
6815 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} not defined,
6816 uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
6817 @option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
6818 used.
6819 @end defmac
6820
6821 @defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6822 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6823 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6824 uninitialized, writable small data.
6825 @end defmac
6826
6827 @defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
6828 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
6829 assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
6830 common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
6831 @end defmac
6832
6833 @defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
6834 If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
6835 containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
6836 default is @code{'T'}.
6837 @end defmac
6838
6839 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6840 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6841 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6842 initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6843 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
6844 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6845 @end defmac
6846
6847 @defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
6848 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6849 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6850 finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6851 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
6852 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6853 @end defmac
6854
6855 @defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6856 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6857 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6858 part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6859 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6860 both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6861 @end defmac
6862
6863 @defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6864 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6865 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6866 part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6867 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6868 both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6869 @end defmac
6870
6871 @defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
6872 If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
6873 via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
6874 the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
6875 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
6876 to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
6877 sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
6878 ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
6879 registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
6880 constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
6881 @end defmac
6882
6883 @defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
6884 If defined, a string which names the section into which small
6885 variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
6886 when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
6887 you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
6888 they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
6889 expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
6890 MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
6891 require small data support from your application, but use this macro
6892 to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
6893 access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
6894 @end defmac
6895
6896 @defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
6897 If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
6898 arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
6899 @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
6900 and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
6901 @end defmac
6902
6903 @defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
6904 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
6905 tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
6906 section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
6907 readonly data section is used.
6908
6909 This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
6910 @end defmac
6911
6912 @hook TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS
6913 Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
6914 @file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
6915 of its own that you need to create.
6916
6917 GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
6918 any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
6919 described below.
6920 @end deftypefn
6921
6922 @hook TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK
6923 Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
6924 selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
6925 should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
6926 local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
6927
6928 The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
6929 is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
6930 when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
6931 in read-only sections even in executables.
6932 @end deftypefn
6933
6934 @hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION
6935 Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
6936 assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
6937 some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
6938 requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
6939 local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
6940 @var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
6941
6942 The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
6943 variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
6944
6945 See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
6946 @end deftypefn
6947
6948 @defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
6949 Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
6950 for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
6951
6952 In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
6953 function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
6954 it is unlikely to be called.
6955 @end defmac
6956
6957 @hook TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION
6958 Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
6959 and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
6960 As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
6961 the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
6962
6963 The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
6964 ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
6965 example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
6966 Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
6967 @end deftypefn
6968
6969 @hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION
6970 Return the readonly data section associated with
6971 @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
6972 The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
6973 the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
6974 if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
6975 otherwise.
6976 @end deftypefn
6977
6978 @hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION
6979 Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
6980 should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
6981 constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
6982 case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
6983 in bits.
6984
6985 The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
6986 constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
6987 else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
6988 @end deftypefn
6989
6990 @hook TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME
6991 Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
6992 by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
6993 the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
6994 or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
6995 hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
6996 your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
6997 returns the @var{id} provided.
6998 @end deftypefn
6999
7000 @hook TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO
7001 Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7002 treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7003 function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7004
7005 The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7006 @var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7007 an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7008 rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7009 in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7010
7011 In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7012 a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7013 will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7014 register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7015 rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7016 leave it alone.)
7017
7018 The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7019 that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
7020 be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7021 declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7022 declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7023 @var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7024
7025 @cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7026 The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7027 @code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7028 Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7029 encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7030 discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7031
7032 The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7033 in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7034 @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7035 before overriding it.
7036 @end deftypefn
7037
7038 @hook TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING
7039 Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7040 the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7041 may have added.
7042 @end deftypefn
7043
7044 @hook TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P
7045 Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7046 The default version of this hook always returns false.
7047 @end deftypefn
7048
7049 @hook TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7050 Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7051 ``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
7052 @end deftypevr
7053
7054 @hook TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
7055
7056 @hook TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P
7057 Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7058 rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7059 or executable image).
7060
7061 The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7062 for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7063 currently supported object file formats.
7064 @end deftypefn
7065
7066 @hook TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7067 Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7068 The default value is false.
7069 @end deftypevr
7070
7071
7072 @node PIC
7073 @section Position Independent Code
7074 @cindex position independent code
7075 @cindex PIC
7076
7077 This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7078 independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7079 generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7080 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7081 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7082 must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7083 when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7084 need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7085 relative addresses.
7086 @c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
7087 @c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7088
7089 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7090 The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7091 data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
7092 processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
7093 is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7094 pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7095 is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7096 necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7097 when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7098 @end defmac
7099
7100 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
7101 A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7102 @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7103 the default is zero. Do not define
7104 this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7105 @end defmac
7106
7107 @defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7108 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7109 operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7110 You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7111 check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7112 check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7113 (including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7114 position independent code.
7115 @end defmac
7116
7117 @node Assembler Format
7118 @section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7119
7120 This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7121 to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7122 instructions do.
7123
7124 @menu
7125 * File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7126 * Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7127 * Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7128 * Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7129 * Initialization:: General principles of initialization
7130 and termination routines.
7131 * Macros for Initialization::
7132 Specific macros that control the handling of
7133 initialization and termination routines.
7134 * Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7135 * Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7136 * Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7137 * Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7138 @end menu
7139
7140 @node File Framework
7141 @subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7142 @cindex assembler format
7143 @cindex output of assembler code
7144
7145 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7146 This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7147
7148 @findex default_file_start
7149 @hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START
7150 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7151 find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7152 by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7153 quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7154 @code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7155 lets other target files rely on these variables.
7156 @end deftypefn
7157
7158 @hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7159 If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7160 printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7161 @option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7162 to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7163 definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7164 assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7165 whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7166
7167 The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7168 verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7169 comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7170 @end deftypevr
7171
7172 @hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7173 If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7174 for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7175 @code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7176 this to be done. The default is false.
7177 @end deftypevr
7178
7179 @hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_END
7180 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7181 to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7182 @end deftypefn
7183
7184 @deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7185 Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7186 special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7187 the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7188 should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7189 need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7190 this function.
7191 @end deftypefun
7192
7193 @hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_START
7194 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7195 to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7196 nothing.
7197 @end deftypefn
7198
7199 @hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_END
7200 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7201 to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7202 nothing.
7203 @end deftypefn
7204
7205 @hook TARGET_ASM_CODE_END
7206 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7207 unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7208 here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7209 because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7210 nothing.
7211 @end deftypefn
7212
7213 @defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7214 A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7215 assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7216 the end of the line.
7217 @end defmac
7218
7219 @defmac ASM_APP_ON
7220 A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7221 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7222 @code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7223 assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7224 that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7225 @end defmac
7226
7227 @defmac ASM_APP_OFF
7228 A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7229 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7230 @code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7231 time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7232 @end defmac
7233
7234 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7235 A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7236 which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7237 the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7238
7239 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7240 for the file format in use is appropriate.
7241 @end defmac
7242
7243 @hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
7244
7245 @defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7246 A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7247 @var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
7248 in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
7249 the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7250 of the filename using this macro.
7251 @end defmac
7252
7253 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7254 A C statement to output something to the assembler file to handle a
7255 @samp{#ident} directive containing the text @var{string}. If this
7256 macro is not defined, nothing is output for a @samp{#ident} directive.
7257 @end defmac
7258
7259 @hook TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION
7260 Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7261 should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
7262 of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7263 is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7264 this section is associated.
7265 @end deftypefn
7266
7267 @hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION
7268 Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.
7269 Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
7270 functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only
7271 at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).
7272 @var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit
7273 (from static destructors).
7274 Return NULL if function should go to default text section.
7275 @end deftypefn
7276
7277 @hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SWITCHED_TEXT_SECTIONS
7278
7279 @hook TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7280 This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
7281 It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
7282 @end deftypevr
7283
7284 @anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
7285 @hook TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
7286 This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7287 section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7288 This is true on most ELF targets.
7289 @end deftypevr
7290
7291 @hook TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS
7292 Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7293 based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7294 declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
7295 null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7296
7297 The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7298 read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7299 need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7300 set via @code{__attribute__}.
7301 @end deftypefn
7302
7303 @hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES
7304 Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7305 switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7306 enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7307 It can take the following values:
7308
7309 @table @gcctabopt
7310 @item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7311 @var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7312
7313 @item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7314 @var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7315 direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7316 default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7317 command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7318 various different individual optimization passes.
7319
7320 @item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7321 @var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7322 ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7323 target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7324 time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7325 warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7326 wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7327 necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7328 perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7329 switches.
7330
7331 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7332 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7333
7334 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7335 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7336 @end table
7337
7338 The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7339 supported in the future.
7340
7341 By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7342 provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7343 it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7344 section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7345 provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7346 hook.
7347 @end deftypefn
7348
7349 @hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
7350 This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7351 ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7352 hook.
7353 @end deftypevr
7354
7355 @need 2000
7356 @node Data Output
7357 @subsection Output of Data
7358
7359
7360 @hook TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7361 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7362 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7363 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7364 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7365 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7366 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7367 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7368 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7369 These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7370 of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7371 byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7372 aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7373 @code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7374
7375 The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7376 followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7377 the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7378 @end deftypevr
7379
7380 @hook TARGET_ASM_INTEGER
7381 The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7382 integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7383 in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7384 function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7385 object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7386 split the object into smaller parts.
7387
7388 The default implementation of this hook will use the
7389 @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7390 when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7391 @end deftypefn
7392
7393 @hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA
7394 A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7395 can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7396 the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7397 @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7398
7399 If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7400 so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7401 itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7402 return @code{true}.
7403 @end deftypefn
7404
7405 @defmac OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{fail})
7406 A C statement to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that
7407 @code{output_addr_const} can't deal with, and output assembly code to
7408 @var{stream} corresponding to the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to
7409 allow machine-dependent @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7410
7411 If @code{OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA} fails to recognize a pattern, it must
7412 @code{goto fail}, so that a standard error message is printed. If it
7413 prints an error message itself, by calling, for example,
7414 @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just complete normally.
7415 @end defmac
7416
7417 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
7418 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7419 instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7420 bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7421 @code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7422
7423 If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7424 Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7425 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
7426 @end defmac
7427
7428 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
7429 A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7430 @var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7431 is defined, and is otherwise unused.
7432 @end defmac
7433
7434 @defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
7435 You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
7436 expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
7437 pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
7438 GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7439 not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
7440 pool before the function.
7441 @end defmac
7442
7443 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
7444 A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7445 constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7446 the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7447 be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7448 is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7449 immediately after this call.
7450
7451 If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7452 not be defined.
7453 @end defmac
7454
7455 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
7456 A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7457 constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7458 anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7459
7460 The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7461 assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7462 output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7463 @samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7464 @var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7465 alignment.
7466
7467 The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7468 the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7469 responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7470 Here is how to do this:
7471
7472 @smallexample
7473 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
7474 @end smallexample
7475
7476 When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7477 @code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7478 entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7479
7480 You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
7481 @end defmac
7482
7483 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
7484 A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7485 pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7486 function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7487 obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
7488 constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
7489
7490 If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7491 define this macro.
7492 @end defmac
7493
7494 @defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
7495 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
7496 used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7497 to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7498 a line separator uses multiple characters.
7499
7500 If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7501 the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
7502 @end defmac
7503
7504 @hook TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
7505 These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7506 assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7507 default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
7508 @end deftypevr
7509
7510 These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
7511 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7512
7513 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7514 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7515 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7516 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7517 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7518 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7519 These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7520 target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7521 the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7522 @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7523 simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7524 @code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7525 by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7526 it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
7527 32 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7528 on the host machine.
7529
7530 The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7531 using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7532 machine's memory.
7533 @end defmac
7534
7535 @node Uninitialized Data
7536 @subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7537
7538 Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7539 outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7540
7541 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7542 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7543 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7544 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7545 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7546 possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7547 other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7548 backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7549 byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7550 equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7551 the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7552 an ordinary undefined external.
7553
7554 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7555 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7556 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7557
7558 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7559 common global variables are output.
7560 @end defmac
7561
7562 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7563 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7564 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7565 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7566 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7567 as the number of bits.
7568 @end defmac
7569
7570 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7571 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7572 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7573 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7574 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7575 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
7576 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7577 @end defmac
7578
7579 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7580 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7581 @var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
7582 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{alignment}
7583 is the alignment specified as the number of bits.
7584
7585 Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7586 @file{varasm.c} when defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
7587 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7588 before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7589 the name, and a newline.
7590
7591 There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define this macro.
7592 The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7593 switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7594 You do not need to do both.
7595
7596 Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7597 non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7598 efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
7599 not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7600 common in order to save space in the object file.
7601 @end defmac
7602
7603 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7604 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7605 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7606 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7607 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7608
7609 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7610 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7611 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7612
7613 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7614 static variables are output.
7615 @end defmac
7616
7617 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7618 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
7619 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7620 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
7621 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7622 as the number of bits.
7623 @end defmac
7624
7625 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7626 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
7627 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7628 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7629 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
7630 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
7631 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7632 @end defmac
7633
7634 @node Label Output
7635 @subsection Output and Generation of Labels
7636
7637 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7638 This is about outputting labels.
7639
7640 @findex assemble_name
7641 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7642 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7643 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
7644 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7645 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7646 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7647 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7648 @end defmac
7649
7650 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7651 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7652 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
7653 a function.
7654 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7655 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7656 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7657 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7658
7659 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7660 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7661 @end defmac
7662
7663 @findex assemble_name_raw
7664 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7665 Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
7666 to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
7667 @code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
7668 that it is more efficient.
7669 @end defmac
7670
7671 @defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
7672 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7673 size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7674 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
7675 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7676
7677 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
7678 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
7679 for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
7680 macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
7681 define this macro.
7682 @end defmac
7683
7684 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
7685 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7686 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
7687 symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
7688 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7689 provided.
7690 @end defmac
7691
7692 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7693 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7694 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
7695 the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
7696 address.
7697
7698 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7699 provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
7700 @samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
7701 the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
7702 not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
7703 to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
7704 @end defmac
7705
7706 @defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
7707 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7708 type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7709 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
7710 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7711
7712 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7713 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7714 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7715 types at all, do not define this macro.
7716 @end defmac
7717
7718 @defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
7719 A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
7720 the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
7721 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
7722 the default is not to define this macro.
7723
7724 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7725 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7726 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7727 types at all, do not define this macro.
7728 @end defmac
7729
7730 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7731 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7732 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
7733 symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
7734 that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
7735 you should not count on this.
7736
7737 If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
7738 definition of this macro is provided.
7739 @end defmac
7740
7741 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7742 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7743 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7744 function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
7745 outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7746 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
7747 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7748
7749 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7750 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
7751
7752 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
7753 of this macro.
7754 @end defmac
7755
7756 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7757 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7758 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
7759 which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
7760 function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
7761 representing the function.
7762
7763 If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
7764
7765 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
7766 of this macro.
7767 @end defmac
7768
7769 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7770 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7771 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
7772 initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
7773 label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
7774 @var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
7775
7776 If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
7777 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7778
7779 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7780 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
7781 @end defmac
7782
7783 @hook TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME
7784 A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
7785 for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
7786 target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7787 @code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
7788 and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
7789 will be an internal label.
7790
7791 The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
7792 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
7793
7794 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
7795 @end deftypefn
7796
7797 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
7798 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7799 @var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
7800 for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
7801
7802 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7803 nothing.
7804 @end defmac
7805
7806 @defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
7807 A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
7808 once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
7809 chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
7810 initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
7811 something about the size of the object.
7812
7813 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7814 nothing.
7815
7816 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7817 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
7818 @end defmac
7819
7820 @hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL
7821 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7822 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
7823 that is, available for reference from other files.
7824
7825 The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
7826 @code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
7827 @end deftypefn
7828
7829 @hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME
7830 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7831 @var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
7832 global; that is, available for reference from other files.
7833
7834 The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
7835 @end deftypefn
7836
7837 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7838 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7839 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
7840 that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
7841 no other definition is available. Use the expression
7842 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
7843 itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
7844 for making that name weak, and a newline.
7845
7846 If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
7847 support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
7848 macro.
7849 @end defmac
7850
7851 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7852 Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
7853 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
7854 or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
7855 should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
7856 defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
7857 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
7858 to make @var{name} weak.
7859 @end defmac
7860
7861 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7862 Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
7863 symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
7864 declaration of @code{name}.
7865 @end defmac
7866
7867 @defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
7868 A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
7869 supports weak symbols.
7870
7871 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7872 definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
7873 is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
7874 @end defmac
7875
7876 @defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
7877 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
7878
7879 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7880 definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
7881 this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
7882 flag such as @option{-melf}.
7883 @end defmac
7884
7885 @defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
7886 A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
7887 public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
7888 be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
7889 format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
7890 section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
7891 requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
7892 @end defmac
7893
7894 @defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
7895 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
7896 semantics.
7897
7898 If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
7899 definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
7900 definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
7901 you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
7902 setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
7903 be emitted as one-only.
7904 @end defmac
7905
7906 @hook TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY
7907 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
7908 commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
7909 hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
7910 @end deftypefn
7911
7912 @defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
7913 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
7914 that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
7915 The default is @code{0}.
7916
7917 Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
7918 if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
7919 will have undefined references from other translation units, that
7920 symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
7921 thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
7922 (explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
7923 with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
7924
7925 The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
7926 targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
7927 restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
7928 table of contents.
7929 @end defmac
7930
7931 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
7932 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7933 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
7934 symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
7935 not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
7936 declaration.
7937
7938 This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
7939 The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
7940 @end defmac
7941
7942 @hook TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL
7943 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
7944 pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
7945 library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
7946 @end deftypefn
7947
7948 @hook TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED
7949 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
7950 directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
7951 .no_dead_code_strip directive.
7952 @end deftypefn
7953
7954 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7955 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7956 @var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
7957 @var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
7958 is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
7959 systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
7960 @end defmac
7961
7962 @hook TARGET_MANGLE_ASSEMBLER_NAME
7963
7964 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
7965 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
7966 @code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
7967 will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
7968 to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
7969 encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
7970 @end defmac
7971
7972 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
7973 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
7974 result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
7975 @code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
7976 This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
7977 specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
7978 when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
7979 being taken.
7980 @end defmac
7981
7982 @hook TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL
7983 A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
7984 name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
7985
7986 It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
7987 used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
7988 will have name conflicts with internal labels.
7989
7990 It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
7991 object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
7992 should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
7993 beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
7994 convention your system uses, and follow it.
7995
7996 The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
7997 @end deftypefn
7998
7999 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8000 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8001 label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8002 @var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8003 may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8004 systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8005 bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8006 bundles.
8007
8008 If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8009 used.
8010 @end defmac
8011
8012 @defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8013 A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8014 is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8015
8016 This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8017 produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8018 with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8019
8020 If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8021 output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8022 @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8023 string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8024 to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8025 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8026 you should know what it does on your machine.)
8027 @end defmac
8028
8029 @defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8030 A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8031 @code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8032 @var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8033 added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8034
8035 The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8036 produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8037 @var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8038 assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8039 macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8040 internal static variables in different scopes.
8041
8042 Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8043 conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8044 or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8045 between the name and the number will suffice.
8046
8047 If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8048 which is correct for most systems.
8049 @end defmac
8050
8051 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8052 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8053 which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8054
8055 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8056 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8057 correct for most systems.
8058 @end defmac
8059
8060 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8061 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8062 which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8063 to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8064 be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8065 the tree nodes are available.
8066
8067 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8068 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8069 correct for most systems.
8070 @end defmac
8071
8072 @defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8073 A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8074 (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8075 of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8076 current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8077 This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8078 @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8079 @end defmac
8080
8081 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8082 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8083 which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8084 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8085 an undefined weak symbol.
8086
8087 Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8088 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8089 @end defmac
8090
8091 @defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8092 Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8093 Objective-C methods.
8094
8095 The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8096 class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8097 the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8098 @samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8099
8100 These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8101 the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8102 systems define other ways of computing names.
8103
8104 @var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8105 buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8106 @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
8107 50 characters extra.
8108
8109 The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8110 method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8111 @var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8112 in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8113
8114 On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8115 macro to provide more human-readable names.
8116 @end defmac
8117
8118 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_CLASS_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8119 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8120 @var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8121 Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets whose
8122 linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8123 @end defmac
8124
8125 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8126 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8127 @var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8128 unresolved Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets
8129 whose linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8130 @end defmac
8131
8132 @node Initialization
8133 @subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8134 @cindex initialization routines
8135 @cindex termination routines
8136 @cindex constructors, output of
8137 @cindex destructors, output of
8138
8139 The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8140 (also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8141 data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8142 to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8143 @code{main} is called.
8144
8145 Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8146 @dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8147 terminates.
8148
8149 To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8150 must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8151 be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8152 system, you need to specify how to do this.
8153
8154 There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8155 initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8156 Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8157
8158 @findex __CTOR_LIST__
8159 @findex __DTOR_LIST__
8160 The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8161 initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8162 termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8163
8164 Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
8165 0, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8166 the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8167 pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8168 pointer containing zero.
8169
8170 Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8171 @file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8172 time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8173 list; destructors in forward order.
8174
8175 The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8176 formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8177 aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8178 Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8179 object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8180 the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8181 accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8182 Termination functions are handled similarly.
8183
8184 This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8185 @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
8186 support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8187 constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8188 and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8189
8190 When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8191 upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
8192 support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8193 parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
8194 program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8195
8196 @smallexample
8197 ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8198 @end smallexample
8199
8200 The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8201 section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8202 for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8203 files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8204 are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8205
8206 The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8207 compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8208 fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8209 to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8210 of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8211 that invokes the routines we need at startup.
8212
8213 To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8214 macro properly.
8215
8216 If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8217 @code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8218 entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8219 it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8220 after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8221 in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
8222
8223 In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8224 two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8225 and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
8226 @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
8227 entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8228 and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8229 code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
8230 the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
8231 placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8232 a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
8233 @code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
8234 section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8235 the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8236 the initialization process.
8237
8238 The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8239 This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
8240 file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
8241 this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8242 termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8243 an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8244 pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8245 the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8246 initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8247 via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8248 @code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
8249
8250 @ifinfo
8251 The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8252 customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8253 @end ifinfo
8254
8255 @node Macros for Initialization
8256 @subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8257
8258 Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8259 and termination functions:
8260
8261 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
8262 If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8263 operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8264 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8265 using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8266 macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8267 run the initialization functions.
8268 @end defmac
8269
8270 @defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
8271 If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
8272 This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8273 on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8274 be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
8275 @end defmac
8276
8277 @defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
8278 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8279 the following symbol is an initialization routine.
8280 @end defmac
8281
8282 @defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
8283 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8284 the following symbol is a finalization routine.
8285 @end defmac
8286
8287 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8288 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8289 automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8290 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8291 the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
8292 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
8293
8294 This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
8295 shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
8296 exception tables embedded in the code.
8297 @end defmac
8298
8299 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8300 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8301 automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8302 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8303 the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
8304 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
8305 @end defmac
8306
8307 @defmac INVOKE__main
8308 If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8309 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8310 where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8311 useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
8312 @end defmac
8313
8314 @defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
8315 If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8316 compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8317 of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8318 encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
8319 @end defmac
8320
8321 @hook TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
8322 This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8323 collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8324 It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
8325 @end deftypevr
8326
8327 @hook TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR
8328 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8329 the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
8330
8331 Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8332 no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8333 priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8334 otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8335
8336 If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
8337 be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8338 target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8339 is not defined.
8340 @end deftypefn
8341
8342 @hook TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR
8343 This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
8344 functions rather than initialization functions.
8345 @end deftypefn
8346
8347 If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8348 generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
8349
8350 If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8351 constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8352 an object file for constructor functions to be called.
8353
8354 On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
8355 @command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
8356
8357 @defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
8358 Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
8359 object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
8360 object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
8361
8362 This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
8363 part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
8364 @end defmac
8365
8366 @defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
8367 Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
8368 to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8369 @command{nm}.
8370 @end defmac
8371
8372 @defmac NM_FLAGS
8373 @command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
8374 constructors and destructors and LTO info. By default, @option{-n} is
8375 passed. Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
8376 are needed to get the same output format as GNU @command{nm -n}
8377 produces.
8378 @end defmac
8379
8380 If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8381 dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8382 these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8383 termination functions in shared libraries:
8384
8385 @defmac LDD_SUFFIX
8386 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
8387 which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
8388 @end defmac
8389
8390 @defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
8391 Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
8392 of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
8393 of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8394 from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
8395 code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8396 line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
8397 @end defmac
8398
8399 @defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8400 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8401 library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8402 strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8403 constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8404 that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8405 @end defmac
8406
8407 @node Instruction Output
8408 @subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8409
8410 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8411 This describes assembler instruction output.
8412
8413 @defmac REGISTER_NAMES
8414 A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8415 registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8416 register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
8417 @end defmac
8418
8419 @defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8420 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8421 and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8422 registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8423 to registers using alternate names.
8424 @end defmac
8425
8426 @defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
8427 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
8428 name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
8429 machine registers the name overlaps. This macro defines additional
8430 names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
8431 declarations to refer to registers using alternate names. Unlike
8432 @code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
8433 register name implies multiple underlying registers.
8434
8435 This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
8436 @code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
8437 register name. For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
8438 VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
8439 ``s0'' and ``s1''.
8440 @end defmac
8441
8442 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
8443 Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8444 requires different names for the machine instructions.
8445
8446 The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8447 assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8448 macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8449 points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8450 written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8451 opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8452 increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8453 so that it will not be output twice.
8454
8455 In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8456 name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8457 that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8458 care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8459 @var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8460
8461 @findex recog_data.operand
8462 If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
8463 elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
8464
8465 If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8466 in the usual way.
8467 @end defmac
8468
8469 @defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
8470 If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8471 assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8472 they will be output differently.
8473
8474 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8475 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8476 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8477 The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8478 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8479 by changing the contents of the vector.
8480
8481 This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8482 file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8483 can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8484 as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8485 syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8486 writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8487
8488 If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
8489 @end defmac
8490
8491 @hook TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN
8492 If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8493 output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8494 if necessary.
8495
8496 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8497 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8498 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8499 The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8500 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8501 by checking the contents of the vector.
8502 @end deftypefn
8503
8504 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
8505 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8506 assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8507 RTL expression.
8508
8509 @var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8510 of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8511 printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8512 the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8513 operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8514 @var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8515 @var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8516
8517 @findex reg_names
8518 If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8519 The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8520 @code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8521 @code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8522
8523 When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8524 (a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8525 with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8526 @var{code}.
8527 @end defmac
8528
8529 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
8530 A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8531 punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
8532 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8533 punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8534 in this way.
8535 @end defmac
8536
8537 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
8538 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8539 assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8540 whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8541
8542 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
8543 On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
8544 section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
8545 @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
8546 @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
8547 Format}.
8548 @end defmac
8549
8550 @findex dbr_sequence_length
8551 @defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
8552 A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8553 been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8554 determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8555 currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8556 or whatever.
8557
8558 Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8559 reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
8560 explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
8561 @end defmac
8562
8563 @findex final_sequence
8564 Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
8565 prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8566 (i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
8567 found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8568 processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8569 being output.
8570
8571 @findex asm_fprintf
8572 @defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
8573 @defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
8574 @defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
8575 @defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
8576 If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
8577 @samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
8578 @file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
8579 support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
8580 files can define these macros differently.
8581 @end defmac
8582
8583 @defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
8584 If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
8585 statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
8586 the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
8587 printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
8588 statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
8589 generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
8590 specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
8591 The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
8592 string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
8593 upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
8594 @end defmac
8595
8596 @defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
8597 If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
8598 different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
8599 numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
8600 first variant.
8601
8602 If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
8603 @smallexample
8604 @samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
8605 @end smallexample
8606 @noindent
8607 in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
8608 first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
8609 @samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
8610 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
8611 within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
8612 alternatives within the braces than the value of
8613 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
8614
8615 If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
8616 @samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
8617 operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
8618
8619 Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
8620 @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
8621 the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
8622 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
8623 if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
8624 opcodes or operand order.
8625 @end defmac
8626
8627 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8628 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8629 which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
8630 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8631 profiling.
8632 @end defmac
8633
8634 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8635 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8636 which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
8637 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8638 profiling.
8639 @end defmac
8640
8641 @node Dispatch Tables
8642 @subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
8643
8644 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8645 This concerns dispatch tables.
8646
8647 @cindex dispatch table
8648 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
8649 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8650 pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
8651 @var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
8652 definitions of these labels are output using
8653 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
8654 way here. For example,
8655
8656 @smallexample
8657 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
8658 @var{value}, @var{rel})
8659 @end smallexample
8660
8661 You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
8662 dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
8663 will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
8664 @var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
8665 mode and flags can be read.
8666 @end defmac
8667
8668 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
8669 This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
8670 in a dispatch table are absolute.
8671
8672 The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
8673 @var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
8674 a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
8675 definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8676 For example,
8677
8678 @smallexample
8679 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
8680 @end smallexample
8681 @end defmac
8682
8683 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8684 Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
8685 specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
8686 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
8687 jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
8688 @code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
8689
8690 This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
8691 for the table.
8692
8693 If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
8694 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8695 @end defmac
8696
8697 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8698 Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
8699 jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
8700 after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
8701 the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
8702 @var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
8703 of the preceding label.
8704
8705 If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
8706 the jump-table.
8707 @end defmac
8708
8709 @hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL
8710 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
8711 should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
8712 should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
8713 function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
8714 The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
8715 exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
8716 true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
8717
8718 The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
8719 @end deftypefn
8720
8721 @hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL
8722 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
8723 It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
8724 to be broken up according to function.
8725
8726 The default is that no label is emitted.
8727 @end deftypefn
8728
8729 @hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY
8730
8731 @hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT
8732 This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
8733 given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
8734 returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
8735 @end deftypefn
8736
8737 @hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
8738
8739 @node Exception Region Output
8740 @subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
8741
8742 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8743
8744 This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
8745 region.
8746
8747 @defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
8748 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
8749 exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
8750 provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
8751 @file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
8752
8753 You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
8754 unwind information and the default definition does not work.
8755 @end defmac
8756
8757 @defmac EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
8758 If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
8759 data section even though the target supports named sections. This
8760 might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
8761 collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
8762
8763 Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
8764 also defined.
8765 @end defmac
8766
8767 @defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
8768 Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
8769 information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
8770 runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
8771 and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
8772 @end defmac
8773
8774 @defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
8775 An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
8776 that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
8777 @end defmac
8778
8779 @defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
8780 Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8781 information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
8782 Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
8783 @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either @code{UNALIGNED_INT_ASM_OP}
8784 or @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}), GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
8785 @end defmac
8786
8787 @hook TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO
8788 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
8789 by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
8790 should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
8791 @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
8792 should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8793 information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
8794
8795 A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
8796 This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
8797 default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
8798
8799 Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
8800 not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
8801 @var{opts}. In particular, the
8802 setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
8803 macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
8804 depending on this setting.
8805
8806 The default implementation of the hook first honors the
8807 @option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
8808 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}. If
8809 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
8810 must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
8811 @end deftypefn
8812
8813 @hook TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
8814 This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
8815 tables even when exceptions are not used. It must not be modified by
8816 command-line option processing.
8817 @end deftypevr
8818
8819 @defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
8820 Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
8821 should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
8822 instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
8823 @end defmac
8824
8825 @defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
8826 This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
8827 function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
8828 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
8829 alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
8830 minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
8831 the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
8832 @end defmac
8833
8834 @hook TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
8835 Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
8836 end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
8837 Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
8838 true otherwise.
8839 @end deftypevr
8840
8841 @hook TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN
8842 Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
8843 represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
8844 register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
8845 locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
8846 register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8847 If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8848 @end deftypefn
8849
8850 @hook TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA
8851 If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
8852 multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
8853 sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
8854 It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
8855 filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
8856 @var{address} is the address of the table.
8857 @end deftypefn
8858
8859 @hook TARGET_ASM_TTYPE
8860 This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
8861 the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
8862 if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
8863 reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
8864 @end deftypefn
8865
8866 @hook TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
8867 This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
8868 based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
8869 the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
8870 running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
8871 @end deftypevr
8872
8873 @node Alignment Output
8874 @subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
8875
8876 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8877 This describes commands for alignment.
8878
8879 @defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8880 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
8881 a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
8882
8883 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8884 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8885 define the macro.
8886
8887 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8888 to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
8889 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8890 selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
8891 @end defmac
8892
8893 @hook TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8894 The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
8895 @code{JUMP_ALIGN}. This works only if
8896 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8897 @end deftypefn
8898
8899 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
8900 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8901 a @code{BARRIER}.
8902
8903 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8904 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8905 define the macro.
8906 @end defmac
8907
8908 @hook TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
8909 The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
8910 @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
8911 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8912 @end deftypefn
8913
8914 @defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8915 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8916 a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
8917
8918 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8919 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8920 define the macro.
8921
8922 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8923 to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
8924 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8925 selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
8926 @end defmac
8927
8928 @hook TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8929 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
8930 @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
8931 defined.
8932 @end deftypefn
8933
8934 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
8935 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
8936 If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
8937 the maximum of the specified values is used.
8938
8939 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8940 to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
8941 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8942 selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
8943 @end defmac
8944
8945 @hook TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8946 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
8947 to @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
8948 is defined.
8949 @end deftypefn
8950
8951 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
8952 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8953 instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
8954 Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
8955 expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
8956 @end defmac
8957
8958 @defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
8959 Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
8960 text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
8961 This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
8962 produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
8963 section.
8964 @end defmac
8965
8966 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
8967 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8968 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
8969 @var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
8970 @end defmac
8971
8972 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
8973 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
8974 for padding, if necessary.
8975 @end defmac
8976
8977 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
8978 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8979 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
8980 @var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
8981 satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
8982 a C expression of type @code{int}.
8983 @end defmac
8984
8985 @need 3000
8986 @node Debugging Info
8987 @section Controlling Debugging Information Format
8988
8989 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8990 This describes how to specify debugging information.
8991
8992 @menu
8993 * All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
8994 * DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
8995 * DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
8996 * File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
8997 * SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
8998 * VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
8999 @end menu
9000
9001 @node All Debuggers
9002 @subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9003
9004 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9005 These macros affect all debugging formats.
9006
9007 @defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
9008 A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
9009 register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9010 of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9011 some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9012 versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9013 compiler and another for DBX@.
9014
9015 If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9016 used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9017 consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9018 Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9019 expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9020
9021 If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9022 does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9023 redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9024 @end defmac
9025
9026 @defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9027 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9028 variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9029 computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9030 gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9031 that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9032 for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
9033 @option{-g} options is used.
9034 @end defmac
9035
9036 @defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9037 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9038 having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9039 @var{offset}.
9040 @end defmac
9041
9042 @defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9043 A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9044 produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
9045 this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9046 debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9047 @code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9048 @code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9049
9050 When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9051 value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9052 exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9053 value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9054 defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9055
9056 The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9057 user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9058 @option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9059 @end defmac
9060
9061 @node DBX Options
9062 @subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9063
9064 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9065 These are specific options for DBX output.
9066
9067 @defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9068 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9069 in response to the @option{-g} option.
9070 @end defmac
9071
9072 @defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9073 Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9074 in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
9075 @end defmac
9076
9077 @defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9078 Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9079 GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9080 debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9081 macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9082 if there is any occasion to.
9083 @end defmac
9084
9085 @defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9086 Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9087 in the text section.
9088 @end defmac
9089
9090 @defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9091 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9092 use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9093 If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9094 applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9095 @end defmac
9096
9097 @defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9098 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9099 use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9100 value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9101 @code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9102 information format.
9103 @end defmac
9104
9105 @defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9106 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9107 use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9108 name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9109 macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9110 @end defmac
9111
9112 @defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9113 Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9114 @samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9115 describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9116 On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9117 @end defmac
9118
9119 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9120 A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9121 continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9122 exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9123 operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9124 must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9125 with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9126 defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9127 @end defmac
9128
9129 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9130 Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9131 the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9132 a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9133 constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9134 if backslash is correct for your system.
9135 @end defmac
9136
9137 @defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9138 Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9139 outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9140 variable.
9141 @end defmac
9142
9143 @defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9144 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9145 for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9146 @end defmac
9147
9148 @defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9149 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9150 for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9151 provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9152 @end defmac
9153
9154 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9155 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9156 for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9157 ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9158 @end defmac
9159
9160 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9161 The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9162 passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9163 do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
9164 @end defmac
9165
9166 @defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9167 Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9168 arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9169 in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9170 code.
9171 @end defmac
9172
9173 @defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9174 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9175 the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9176 relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9177 an absolute address.
9178 @end defmac
9179
9180 @defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9181 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9182 the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9183 start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9184 @end defmac
9185
9186 @defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9187 Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9188 @code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
9189 macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9190 number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
9191 generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9192 number for a type number.
9193 @end defmac
9194
9195 @node DBX Hooks
9196 @subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9197
9198 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9199 These are hooks for DBX format.
9200
9201 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9202 Define this macro to say how to output to @var{stream} the debugging
9203 information for the start of a scope level for variable names. The
9204 argument @var{name} is the name of an assembler symbol (for use with
9205 @code{assemble_name}) whose value is the address where the scope begins.
9206 @end defmac
9207
9208 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9209 Like @code{DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC}, but for the end of a scope level.
9210 @end defmac
9211
9212 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NFUN (@var{stream}, @var{lscope_label}, @var{decl})
9213 Define this macro if the target machine requires special handling to
9214 output an @code{N_FUN} entry for the function @var{decl}.
9215 @end defmac
9216
9217 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9218 A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9219 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9220 @var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
9221 invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9222 unique labels in the assembly output.
9223
9224 This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9225 if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9226 @end defmac
9227
9228 @defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
9229 Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
9230 @code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
9231 On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9232 disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9233 @end defmac
9234
9235 @defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9236 Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9237 extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9238 feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9239 @end defmac
9240
9241 @node File Names and DBX
9242 @subsection File Names in DBX Format
9243
9244 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9245 This describes file names in DBX format.
9246
9247 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9248 A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
9249 @var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
9250 file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9251 This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9252
9253 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9254 for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
9255
9256 It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9257 text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9258 to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9259 @var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
9260 @end defmac
9261
9262 @defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9263 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9264 of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9265 the beginning of the file.
9266 @end defmac
9267
9268 @defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9269 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9270 that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9271 an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9272 @samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
9273 @end defmac
9274
9275 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9276 A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
9277 compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9278 written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9279
9280 If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9281 of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
9282 @end defmac
9283
9284 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9285 Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9286 @code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
9287 the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
9288 whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9289 @end defmac
9290
9291 @need 2000
9292 @node SDB and DWARF
9293 @subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9294
9295 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9296 Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9297
9298 @defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
9299 Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
9300 for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
9301 @end defmac
9302
9303 @defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
9304 Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
9305 debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
9306
9307 @hook TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION
9308 Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9309 be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9310 value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9311 @end deftypefn
9312
9313 To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9314 define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9315 @code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9316 prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
9317 as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
9318 @end defmac
9319
9320 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
9321 Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
9322 Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9323 (@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9324 exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9325 how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
9326 @end defmac
9327
9328 @hook TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO
9329 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9330 unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9331 @code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9332 return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9333
9334 A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9335 is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9336
9337 A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9338 This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9339 @end deftypefn
9340
9341 @defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
9342 Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9343 line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9344 tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
9345 @end defmac
9346
9347 @hook TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9348
9349 @hook TARGET_DELAY_SCHED2
9350
9351 @hook TARGET_DELAY_VARTRACK
9352
9353 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9354 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9355 @var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9356 @end defmac
9357
9358 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9359 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9360 between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9361 slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9362 @end defmac
9363
9364 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
9365 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
9366 section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
9367 given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
9368 @end defmac
9369
9370 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9371 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
9372 reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9373 @end defmac
9374
9375 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9376 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9377 the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9378 is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9379 is referenced by a function.
9380 @end defmac
9381
9382 @hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL
9383 If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9384 reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9385 @end deftypefn
9386
9387 @defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
9388 Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9389 SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9390 macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9391 not define them yourself.
9392 @end defmac
9393
9394 @defmac SDB_DELIM
9395 Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9396 SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9397 delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9398 a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9399 required.
9400 @end defmac
9401
9402 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
9403 Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9404 union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9405 allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9406 it.
9407 @end defmac
9408
9409 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
9410 Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9411 enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9412 assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
9413 @end defmac
9414
9415 @defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9416 A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9417 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9418 @var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9419 @end defmac
9420
9421 @need 2000
9422 @node VMS Debug
9423 @subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9424
9425 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9426 Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9427
9428 @defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9429 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9430 in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9431 is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9432 @option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
9433 behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
9434 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
9435 @end defmac
9436
9437 @node Floating Point
9438 @section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9439 @cindex cross compilation and floating point
9440 @cindex floating point and cross compilation
9441
9442 While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
9443 there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9444 means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9445 in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9446 doing the compilation.
9447
9448 Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
9449 range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9450 the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9451 safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9452 the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9453 emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9454 target floating point formats are identical.
9455
9456 The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9457 use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
9458 floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9459 their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
9460
9461 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9462 The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9463 machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9464 array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9465 quantity.
9466 @end defmac
9467
9468 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9469 Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}. If the target
9470 floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
9471 @samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
9472 @samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
9473 @end deftypefn
9474
9475 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9476 Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
9477 @end deftypefn
9478
9479 @deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9480 Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9481 @end deftypefn
9482
9483 @deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9484 Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9485 @var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9486 @end deftypefn
9487
9488 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9489 Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9490 representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9491 decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9492 defined by the C language for both.
9493 @end deftypefn
9494
9495 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9496 Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
9497 @end deftypefn
9498
9499 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9500 Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9501 @end deftypefn
9502
9503 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9504 Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9505 @end deftypefn
9506
9507 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9508 Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
9509 @var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
9510 variable).
9511
9512 The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}. Only the
9513 following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
9514 @code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
9515
9516 If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
9517 target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
9518 @code{abort}. Callers should check for this situation first, using
9519 @code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}. @xref{Storage Layout}.
9520 @end deftypefn
9521
9522 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9523 Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9524 @end deftypefn
9525
9526 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9527 Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9528 @end deftypefn
9529
9530 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{x})
9531 Truncates the floating point value @var{x} to fit in @var{mode}. The
9532 return value is still a full-size @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, but it has an
9533 appropriate bit pattern to be output as a floating constant whose
9534 precision accords with mode @var{mode}.
9535 @end deftypefn
9536
9537 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9538 Converts a floating point value @var{x} into a double-precision integer
9539 which is then stored into @var{low} and @var{high}. If the value is not
9540 integral, it is truncated.
9541 @end deftypefn
9542
9543 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9544 Converts a double-precision integer found in @var{low} and @var{high},
9545 into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}. The
9546 value is truncated to fit in mode @var{mode}.
9547 @end deftypefn
9548
9549 @node Mode Switching
9550 @section Mode Switching Instructions
9551 @cindex mode switching
9552 The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9553
9554 @defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9555 Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9556 switching in an optimizing compilation.
9557
9558 For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9559 floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9560 the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9561 operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
9562 purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
9563 be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
9564 or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9565
9566 You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9567 which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
9568 return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9569 If you define this macro, you also have to define
9570 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
9571 @code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
9572 @code{MODE_AFTER}, @code{MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{MODE_EXIT}
9573 are optional.
9574 @end defmac
9575
9576 @defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9577 If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9578 initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
9579 N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9580 of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
9581 The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9582 zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9583 entity in question.
9584 In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
9585 represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
9586 switch is needed / supplied.
9587 @end defmac
9588
9589 @defmac MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
9590 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
9591 @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
9592 return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
9593 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
9594 be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
9595 @end defmac
9596
9597 @defmac MODE_AFTER (@var{mode}, @var{insn})
9598 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during
9599 mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if
9600 different from the incoming mode).
9601 @end defmac
9602
9603 @defmac MODE_ENTRY (@var{entity})
9604 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9605 mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9606 @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{MODE_ENTRY}
9607 is defined then @code{MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
9608 @end defmac
9609
9610 @defmac MODE_EXIT (@var{entity})
9611 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9612 mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9613 @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{MODE_EXIT}
9614 is defined then @code{MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
9615 @end defmac
9616
9617 @defmac MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
9618 This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
9619 0 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
9620 lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
9621 for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
9622 (@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
9623 @code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
9624 @end defmac
9625
9626 @defmac EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
9627 Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
9628 @var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
9629 the insn(s) are to be inserted.
9630 @end defmac
9631
9632 @node Target Attributes
9633 @section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
9634 @cindex target attributes
9635 @cindex machine attributes
9636 @cindex attributes, target-specific
9637
9638 Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
9639 These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
9640 be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
9641
9642 @hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9643 If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
9644 attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
9645 specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
9646 entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
9647 take.
9648 @end deftypevr
9649
9650 @hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P
9651 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
9652 machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
9653 given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
9654 subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
9655 false for all machine-specific attributes.
9656 @end deftypefn
9657
9658 @hook TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9659 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
9660 @var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
9661 and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
9662 generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
9663 supposed always to be compatible.
9664 @end deftypefn
9665
9666 @hook TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9667 If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
9668 the newly defined @var{type}.
9669 @end deftypefn
9670
9671 @hook TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9672 Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
9673 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9674 @code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
9675 that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
9676 function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
9677 merging.
9678 @end deftypefn
9679
9680 @hook TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9681 Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
9682 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9683 @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
9684 @var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
9685 when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
9686 attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
9687 call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
9688
9689 @findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9690 If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
9691 for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
9692 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
9693 will then define a function called
9694 @code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
9695 the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
9696 add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
9697 to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
9698 @samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
9699 @file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
9700 @end deftypefn
9701
9702 @hook TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P
9703
9704 @defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
9705 Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
9706 @code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
9707 default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
9708 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
9709 of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
9710 on this implementation detail.
9711 @end defmac
9712
9713 @hook TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES
9714 Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
9715 when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
9716 wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
9717 the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
9718 created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
9719 for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
9720 shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
9721 the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
9722 attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
9723 needed.
9724 @end deftypefn
9725
9726 @hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P
9727 @cindex inlining
9728 This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
9729 into the current function, despite its having target-specific
9730 attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
9731 target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
9732 @end deftypefn
9733
9734 @hook TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P
9735 This hook is called to parse the @code{attribute(option("..."))}, and
9736 it allows the function to set different target machine compile time
9737 options for the current function that might be different than the
9738 options specified on the command line. The hook should return
9739 @code{true} if the options are valid.
9740
9741 The hook should set the @var{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
9742 the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target specific
9743 @var{struct cl_target_option} structure.
9744 @end deftypefn
9745
9746 @hook TARGET_OPTION_SAVE
9747 This hook is called to save any additional target specific information
9748 in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for function specific
9749 options.
9750 @xref{Option file format}.
9751 @end deftypefn
9752
9753 @hook TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE
9754 This hook is called to restore any additional target specific
9755 information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9756 function specific options.
9757 @end deftypefn
9758
9759 @hook TARGET_OPTION_PRINT
9760 This hook is called to print any additional target specific
9761 information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9762 function specific options.
9763 @end deftypefn
9764
9765 @hook TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE
9766 This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC option} to
9767 set the machine specific options for functions that occur later in the
9768 input stream. The options should be the same as handled by the
9769 @code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
9770 @end deftypefn
9771
9772 @hook TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE
9773 Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
9774 a particular target machine. You can override the hook
9775 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
9776 once just after all the command options have been parsed.
9777
9778 Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
9779 @option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
9780
9781 If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
9782 changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
9783 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
9784 @end deftypefn
9785
9786 @hook TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P
9787 This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
9788 cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
9789 default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
9790 specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
9791 @end deftypefn
9792
9793 @node Emulated TLS
9794 @section Emulating TLS
9795 @cindex Emulated TLS
9796
9797 For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
9798 specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
9799 used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
9800 configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
9801 the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
9802 layer.
9803
9804 The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
9805 object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
9806 which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
9807 address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
9808
9809 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
9810 Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
9811 object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
9812 emulated TLS helper function to be used.
9813 @end deftypevr
9814
9815 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
9816 Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
9817 program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
9818 initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
9819 have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
9820 registration function to be used.
9821 @end deftypevr
9822
9823 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
9824 Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
9825 be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
9826 any section.
9827 @end deftypevr
9828
9829 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
9830 Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
9831 placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
9832 section.
9833 @end deftypevr
9834
9835 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
9836 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
9837 The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9838 @end deftypevr
9839
9840 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
9841 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
9842 default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9843 @end deftypevr
9844
9845 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS
9846 Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
9847 object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
9848 @var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
9849 @code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
9850 for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
9851 @end deftypefn
9852
9853 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT
9854 Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
9855 TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
9856 is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
9857 initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
9858 @end deftypefn
9859
9860 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
9861 Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
9862 fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
9863 single objects. The default is false.
9864 @end deftypevr
9865
9866 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
9867 Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
9868 may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
9869 @end deftypevr
9870
9871 @node MIPS Coprocessors
9872 @section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
9873 @cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
9874
9875 The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
9876 coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
9877 accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
9878 and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
9879
9880 @smallexample
9881 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
9882 unsigned int d;
9883
9884 d = cp0count + 3;
9885 @end smallexample
9886
9887 (``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
9888 names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
9889 overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
9890
9891 Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
9892 be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
9893 later in the function.
9894
9895 Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
9896 the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
9897 floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
9898
9899 There is one macro used in defining the MIPS coprocessor interface which
9900 you may want to override in subtargets; it is described below.
9901
9902 @defmac ALL_COP_ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
9903 A comma-separated list (with leading comma) of pairs describing the
9904 alternate names of coprocessor registers. The format of each entry should be
9905 @smallexample
9906 @{ @var{alternatename}, @var{register_number}@}
9907 @end smallexample
9908 Default: empty.
9909 @end defmac
9910
9911 @node PCH Target
9912 @section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
9913 @cindex parameters, precompiled headers
9914
9915 @hook TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY
9916 This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
9917 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
9918 @samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
9919 @end deftypefn
9920
9921 @hook TARGET_PCH_VALID_P
9922 This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
9923 compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
9924 if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
9925 be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
9926
9927 @var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
9928 when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
9929 It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
9930 compiler, so no format checking is needed.
9931
9932 The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
9933 suitable for most targets.
9934 @end deftypefn
9935
9936 @hook TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS
9937 If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
9938 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
9939 of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
9940 @code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
9941 value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
9942 @end deftypefn
9943
9944 @node C++ ABI
9945 @section C++ ABI parameters
9946 @cindex parameters, c++ abi
9947
9948 @hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE
9949 Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
9950 These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
9951 default is long_long_integer_type_node.
9952 @end deftypefn
9953
9954 @hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT
9955 This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
9956 @code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
9957 @code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
9958 @end deftypefn
9959
9960 @hook TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE
9961 This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
9962 whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
9963 known that a cookie is needed. The default is
9964 @code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
9965 IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
9966 @end deftypefn
9967
9968 @hook TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE
9969 This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
9970 array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
9971 @end deftypefn
9972
9973 @hook TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS
9974 If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
9975 class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
9976 will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
9977 to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
9978 modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
9979 backend's targeted operating system.
9980 @end deftypefn
9981
9982 @hook TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS
9983 This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
9984 the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
9985 @code{false}.
9986 @end deftypefn
9987
9988 @hook TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE
9989 This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
9990 which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
9991 table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
9992 Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
9993 the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
9994 some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
9995 method. The default is to return @code{true}.
9996 @end deftypefn
9997
9998 @hook TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY
9999
10000 @hook TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT
10001 This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10002 similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10003 external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
10004 classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10005 unit will not be COMDAT.
10006 @end deftypefn
10007
10008 @hook TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT
10009 This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10010 the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10011 be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10012 @end deftypefn
10013
10014 @hook TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT
10015 This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10016 should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10017 is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10018 @end deftypefn
10019
10020 @hook TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT
10021 This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10022 in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10023 destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10024 shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10025 unloaded. The default is to return false.
10026 @end deftypefn
10027
10028 @hook TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION
10029
10030 @node Named Address Spaces
10031 @section Adding support for named address spaces
10032 @cindex named address spaces
10033
10034 The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10035 standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10036 support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10037 processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10038 GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10039 address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10040 spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10041 @code{const} type attributes.
10042
10043 Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10044 pointers to the generic address space.
10045
10046 For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10047 to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10048 processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10049 issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10050 local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10051 address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10052 @option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10053 always 32 bits).
10054
10055 Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10056 range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10057 address space.
10058
10059 To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10060 the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10061 the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10062 named address space #1:
10063 @smallexample
10064 #define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10065 c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10066 @end smallexample
10067
10068 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE
10069 Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10070 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10071 The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode} for the
10072 generic address space only.
10073 @end deftypefn
10074
10075 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE
10076 Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10077 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10078 The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode} for the
10079 generic address space only.
10080 @end deftypefn
10081
10082 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE
10083 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10084 with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10085 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10086 except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10087 version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10088 @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10089 target hooks for the given address space.
10090 @end deftypefn
10091
10092 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
10093 Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10094 @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10095 parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10096 finished. This target hook is the same as the
10097 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10098 explicit named address space support.
10099 @end deftypefn
10100
10101 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
10102 Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10103 with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10104 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10105 except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10106 @end deftypefn
10107
10108 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P
10109 Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10110 contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10111 a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10112 will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10113 arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
10114 converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10115 @end deftypefn
10116
10117 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT
10118 Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10119 @var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10120 space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10121 to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10122 guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10123 as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10124 @end deftypefn
10125
10126 @node Misc
10127 @section Miscellaneous Parameters
10128 @cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10129
10130 @c prevent bad page break with this line
10131 Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10132
10133 @defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10134 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10135 has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10136 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10137 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10138 set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10139 to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10140 @end defmac
10141
10142 @defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10143 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10144 has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10145 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10146 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10147 set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10148 to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10149 @end defmac
10150
10151 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10152 An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10153 elements of a jump-table should have.
10154 @end defmac
10155
10156 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10157 Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10158 when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10159 it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10160 To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10161 make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10162 The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10163 flags can be updated.
10164 @end defmac
10165
10166 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10167 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10168 should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10169 jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10170 contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10171 is in effect.
10172 @end defmac
10173
10174 @hook TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
10175 This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10176 is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10177 The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10178 five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
10179 @end deftypefn
10180
10181 @defmac CASE_USE_BIT_TESTS
10182 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate whether C switch
10183 statements may be implemented by a sequence of bit tests. This is
10184 advantageous on processors that can efficiently implement left shift
10185 of 1 by the number of bits held in a register, but inappropriate on
10186 targets that would require a loop. By default, this macro returns
10187 @code{true} if the target defines an @code{ashlsi3} pattern, and
10188 @code{false} otherwise.
10189 @end defmac
10190
10191 @defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10192 Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
10193 smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10194 Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10195 @end defmac
10196
10197 @defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
10198 Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
10199 memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10200 bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
10201 zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
10202 of @var{mem_mode} for which the
10203 insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
10204 @code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
10205
10206 This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
10207 greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10208 value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
10209 @code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
10210 define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
10211
10212 You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
10213 the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10214 of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10215 when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10216 integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10217
10218 You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
10219 mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10220 @code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10221 is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
10222 @end defmac
10223
10224 @defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
10225 Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10226 extends.
10227 @end defmac
10228
10229 @defmac FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
10230 Define this macro if the same instructions that convert a floating
10231 point number to a signed fixed point number also convert validly to an
10232 unsigned one.
10233 @end defmac
10234
10235 @hook TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL
10236 When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10237 divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10238 the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10239 that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10240 of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10241 has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10242 @end deftypefn
10243
10244 @defmac MOVE_MAX
10245 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10246 between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
10247 @end defmac
10248
10249 @defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
10250 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10251 between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10252 is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10253 constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10254 at run-time.
10255 @end defmac
10256
10257 @defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
10258 A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10259 actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10260 of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
10261 this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
10262 a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10263 truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
10264 instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
10265 include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10266 also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
10267 arguments to bit-field instructions.
10268
10269 If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
10270 position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
10271 instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10272
10273 However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10274 only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
10275 bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
10276 such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10277 the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10278
10279 You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
10280 @end defmac
10281
10282 @anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
10283 @hook TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK
10284 This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10285 deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10286 @xref{shift patterns}.
10287
10288 On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10289 shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10290 equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10291 this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10292 otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10293 particular behavior is guaranteed.
10294
10295 Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10296 @emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10297 that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10298
10299 The default implementation of this function returns
10300 @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10301 and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10302 @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10303 nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10304 by overriding it.
10305 @end deftypefn
10306
10307 @defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
10308 A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10309 ``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10310 bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10311 operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10312
10313 On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10314
10315 @c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10316 @c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10317 When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10318 modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10319 If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10320 such cases may improve things.
10321 @end defmac
10322
10323 @hook TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED
10324 The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
10325 are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10326 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10327 sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10328 otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10329 representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10330 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10331 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
10332 @var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
10333 widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10334
10335 Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10336 value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10337 as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10338 @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10339
10340 Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10341 describe two related properties. If you define
10342 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10343 to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10344 extension.
10345
10346 In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10347 @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10348 @code{mode}.
10349 @end deftypefn
10350
10351 @defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
10352 A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10353 with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
10354 (@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10355 apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
10356 comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10357
10358 A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10359 comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
10360 and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10361 which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10362 true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10363 operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
10364 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
10365 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10366 the compiler.
10367
10368 If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
10369 generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10370 replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10371 the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10372 For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10373 @code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10374 @samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10375 expression
10376
10377 @smallexample
10378 (ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10379 @end smallexample
10380
10381 @noindent
10382 can be converted to
10383
10384 @smallexample
10385 (ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10386 @end smallexample
10387
10388 @noindent
10389 where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10390 tested into the sign bit.
10391
10392 There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10393 for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10394 but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
10395 are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
10396 perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
10397 comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
10398
10399 Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10400 from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10401 choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10402 to be used:
10403
10404 @itemize @bullet
10405 @item
10406 Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10407 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10408 ``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10409 comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10410 combine the normalization with other operations.
10411
10412 @item
10413 For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
10414 slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10415 other machines.
10416
10417 @item
10418 As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10419 exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10420 others.
10421
10422 @item
10423 Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10424 @end itemize
10425
10426 Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10427 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10428 instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10429 those cases, e.g., one matching
10430
10431 @smallexample
10432 (set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10433 @end smallexample
10434
10435 Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10436 condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
10437 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
10438 machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10439 and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10440 @code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
10441 @file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptimizer can be used to
10442 find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10443
10444 If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10445 not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10446 instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
10447 @end defmac
10448
10449 @defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10450 A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
10451 returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
10452 Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
10453 floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10454 this macro.
10455 @end defmac
10456
10457 @defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10458 A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
10459 for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10460 mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10461 this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10462 return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10463 this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10464 @code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10465 the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10466 given mode.
10467 @end defmac
10468
10469 @defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10470 @defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10471 A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
10472 for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
10473 A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10474 If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10475 evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10476 entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
10477 the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
10478 In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
10479 this value.
10480
10481 If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10482 @code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
10483
10484 This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10485 relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
10486 is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10487 to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
10488
10489 Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10490 and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10491 visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10492 to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
10493 breaking the API@.
10494 @end defmac
10495
10496 @defmac Pmode
10497 An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10498 this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10499 pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10500 On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10501 modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10502
10503 The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10504 @code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10505 @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10506 to @code{Pmode}.
10507 @end defmac
10508
10509 @defmac FUNCTION_MODE
10510 An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
10511 being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
10512 where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
10513 @code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10514 size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10515 as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
10516 @end defmac
10517
10518 @defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
10519 In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10520 constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10521 hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10522 where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10523 strict conformance to the C Standard.
10524
10525 Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10526 convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10527 files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
10528 @end defmac
10529
10530 @defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
10531 Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
10532 This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10533 C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10534 @samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
10535 @end defmac
10536
10537 @findex #pragma
10538 @findex pragma
10539 @defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
10540 Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
10541 If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
10542 @code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10543 for each pragma. The macro may also do any
10544 setup required for the pragmas.
10545
10546 The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10547 other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
10548 definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
10549
10550 If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
10551 defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
10552
10553 Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
10554 @samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
10555 silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
10556 @end defmac
10557
10558 @deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10559 @deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10560
10561 Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10562 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
10563 @var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10564 pragma of the form
10565
10566 @smallexample
10567 #pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10568 @end smallexample
10569
10570 @var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10571 @code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
10572 routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
10573 on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
10574 @var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
10575 callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
10576 a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
10577 arguments of pragmas registered with
10578 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
10579 pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
10580
10581 Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
10582 compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
10583 other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
10584 to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
10585 building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
10586 variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
10587 target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
10588 the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
10589 code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
10590 rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
10591 how to build this object file.
10592 @end deftypefun
10593
10594 @defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
10595 Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
10596 arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
10597 @end defmac
10598
10599 @hook TARGET_HANDLE_PRAGMA_EXTERN_PREFIX
10600
10601 @defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
10602 If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
10603 the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
10604 This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
10605 @samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
10606 @end defmac
10607
10608 @defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
10609 Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
10610 identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
10611 not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
10612 there is no need to define this macro in that case.
10613 @end defmac
10614
10615 @defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
10616 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10617 @samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
10618 G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
10619 @samp{.} is used instead.
10620 @end defmac
10621
10622 @defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
10623 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10624 @samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
10625 have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
10626 are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
10627 @end defmac
10628
10629 @defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10630 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10631 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10632 even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
10633 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
10634 every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
10635 or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
10636 you should define this macro.
10637
10638 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10639 @end defmac
10640
10641 @defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10642 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10643 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10644 even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
10645 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
10646 some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
10647 are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
10648 define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
10649 instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
10650 slot of @var{insn}.
10651
10652 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10653 @end defmac
10654
10655 @defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
10656 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
10657 global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
10658 symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
10659 instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
10660 from shared libraries (DLLs).
10661
10662 You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
10663 @end defmac
10664
10665 @hook TARGET_MD_ASM_CLOBBERS
10666 This target hook should add to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
10667 any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for an asm.
10668 It should return the result of the last @code{tree_cons} used to add a
10669 clobber. The @var{outputs}, @var{inputs} and @var{clobber} lists are the
10670 corresponding parameters to the asm and may be inspected to avoid
10671 clobbering a register that is an input or output of the asm. You can use
10672 @code{tree_overlaps_hard_reg_set}, declared in @file{tree.h}, to test
10673 for overlap with regards to asm-declared registers.
10674 @end deftypefn
10675
10676 @defmac MATH_LIBRARY
10677 Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
10678 in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
10679 @samp{""} if the target does not have a
10680 separate math library.
10681
10682 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
10683 @end defmac
10684
10685 @defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
10686 Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
10687 specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
10688
10689 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
10690 is wrong.
10691 @end defmac
10692
10693 @defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
10694 Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
10695 functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
10696 Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
10697 to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
10698 if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
10699 for cross-profiling.
10700 @end defmac
10701
10702 @defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
10703
10704 A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
10705 conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
10706 @code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
10707 1 if it does use cc0.
10708 @end defmac
10709
10710 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10711 Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
10712 conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
10713 @var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
10714 contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
10715 and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
10716 then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
10717 @var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
10718 @end defmac
10719
10720 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10721 Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
10722 if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
10723 @var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
10724 being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
10725 @end defmac
10726
10727 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
10728 A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
10729 be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
10730 a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
10731 about the currently processed blocks.
10732 @end defmac
10733
10734 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
10735 A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
10736 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10737 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10738 to by @var{ce_info}.
10739 @end defmac
10740
10741 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
10742 A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
10743 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10744 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10745 to by @var{ce_info}.
10746 @end defmac
10747
10748 @defmac IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS (@var{ce_info})
10749 A C expression to initialize any extra fields in a @code{struct ce_if_block}
10750 structure, which are defined by the @code{IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10751 @end defmac
10752
10753 @defmac IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS
10754 If defined, it should expand to a set of field declarations that will be
10755 added to the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure. These should be initialized
10756 by the @code{IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10757 @end defmac
10758
10759 @hook TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
10760 If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
10761 instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
10762 just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
10763
10764 The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
10765 it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
10766 laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
10767 Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
10768
10769 You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
10770 definition is null.
10771 @end deftypefn
10772
10773 @hook TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS
10774 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10775 that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
10776 necessary setup.
10777
10778 Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
10779 instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
10780 they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
10781 instructions or prefetch instructions).
10782
10783 To create a built-in function, call the function
10784 @code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
10785 which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
10786 up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes} and @code{build_common_tree_nodes_2};
10787 only language front ends that use those two functions will call
10788 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
10789 @end deftypefn
10790
10791 @hook TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL
10792 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10793 that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
10794 builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
10795 If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
10796 if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
10797 If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
10798 @code{error_mark_node}.
10799 @end deftypefn
10800
10801 @hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN
10802
10803 Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10804 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
10805 function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
10806 convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
10807 @var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
10808 @var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
10809 ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
10810 built-in function.
10811 @end deftypefn
10812
10813 @hook TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN
10814 Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
10815 was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
10816 @emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
10817 implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
10818 declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
10819 arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
10820 complete expression that implements the operation, usually
10821 another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
10822 @var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
10823 @end deftypefn
10824
10825 @hook TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN
10826 Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10827 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
10828 built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
10829 the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
10830 The result is another tree containing a simplified expression for the
10831 call's result. If @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
10832 @end deftypefn
10833
10834 @hook TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP
10835
10836 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
10837 low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
10838 could not be applied.
10839
10840 Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
10841 instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
10842 the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
10843 By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
10844 loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
10845 @end deftypefn
10846
10847 @defmac MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH (@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
10848
10849 Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
10850 Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
10851 @var{branch2} is possible.
10852
10853 On some targets, branches may have a limited range. Optimizing the
10854 filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
10855 may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
10856 @end defmac
10857
10858 @hook TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P
10859 This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
10860 Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
10861 PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
10862 of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
10863 @end deftypefn
10864
10865 @hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE
10866
10867 When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
10868 register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
10869 to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
10870 it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
10871 is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
10872 that had its initial value copied by using
10873 @code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
10874 Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
10875 to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
10876 the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
10877 @code{MEM}.
10878 If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
10879 it might decide to use another register anyways.
10880 You may use @code{current_function_leaf_function} in the hook, functions
10881 that use @code{REG_N_SETS}, to determine if the hard
10882 register in question will not be clobbered.
10883 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
10884 allocation.
10885 @end deftypefn
10886
10887 @hook TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P
10888 This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
10889 @code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
10890 this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
10891 @code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
10892 to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
10893 passed along.
10894 @end deftypefn
10895
10896 @hook TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION
10897 The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
10898 context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
10899 the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
10900 per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
10901 attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
10902 The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
10903 and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
10904 and is returning to processing at the top level.
10905 The default hook function does nothing.
10906
10907 GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
10908 some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
10909 situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
10910 or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
10911 @code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
10912 outside of any function scope.
10913 @end deftypefn
10914
10915 @defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
10916 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
10917 files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
10918 use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
10919 @end defmac
10920
10921 @defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
10922 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
10923 automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
10924 do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
10925 executable files.
10926 @end defmac
10927
10928 @defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
10929 If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
10930 specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
10931 Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
10932 object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
10933 lists.
10934 @end defmac
10935
10936 @defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
10937 Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
10938 method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
10939 must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
10940 For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
10941 the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
10942 defined as this expression:
10943
10944 @smallexample
10945 build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
10946 build_tree_list
10947 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
10948 NULL))
10949 @end smallexample
10950 @end defmac
10951
10952 @hook TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P
10953 This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
10954 instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
10955 every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
10956 reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
10957
10958 @smallexample
10959 static bool
10960 cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
10961 @{
10962 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
10963 @}
10964 @end smallexample
10965 @end deftypefn
10966
10967 @hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS
10968 This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
10969 optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
10970 usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
10971 re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
10972 to inter-block scheduling.
10973 @end deftypefn
10974
10975 @hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED
10976 Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
10977 registers
10978 that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
10979 returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
10980 that all target registers in the class returned by
10981 @samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
10982 saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
10983 epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
10984 true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
10985 to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
10986 to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
10987 @end deftypefn
10988
10989 @hook TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION
10990 This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
10991 This target hook is required only when the target has several different
10992 modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
10993 @end deftypefn
10994
10995 @hook TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST
10996 This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
10997 should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
10998 the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
10999 the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11000 is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11001 number of memory accesses.
11002 @end deftypefn
11003
11004 @defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
11005 If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
11006 that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11007 that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11008 constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11009 more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11010 system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11011 The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11012 @end defmac
11013
11014 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11015 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11016 target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
11017 are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11018 The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11019 @end deftypefn
11020
11021 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11022 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11023 target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11024 indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11025 @var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11026 @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11027 @end deftypefn
11028
11029 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11030 This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11031 The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11032 systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11033 that are different from @option{-I}.
11034 @end deftypefn
11035
11036 @defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11037 This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11038 for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11039 @code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11040 functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11041 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11042 @end defmac
11043
11044 @defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11045 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11046 target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11047 option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11048 @end defmac
11049
11050 @defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11051 If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11052 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11053 @end defmac
11054
11055 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11056 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11057 target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11058 default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11059 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11060 @end defmac
11061
11062 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11063 If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11064 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11065 @end defmac
11066
11067 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11068 If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11069 routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11070 and scanf formatter settings.
11071 @end defmac
11072
11073 @hook TARGET_RELAXED_ORDERING
11074 If set to @code{true}, means that the target's memory model does not
11075 guarantee that loads which do not depend on one another will access
11076 main memory in the order of the instruction stream; if ordering is
11077 important, an explicit memory barrier must be used. This is true of
11078 many recent processors which implement a policy of ``relaxed,''
11079 ``weak,'' or ``release'' memory consistency, such as Alpha, PowerPC,
11080 and ia64. The default is @code{false}.
11081 @end deftypevr
11082
11083 @hook TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN
11084 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11085 illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11086 with prototype @var{typelist}.
11087 @end deftypefn
11088
11089 @hook TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION
11090 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11091 invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11092 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11093 @end deftypefn
11094
11095 @hook TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP
11096 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11097 invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11098 @code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11099 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11100 @end deftypefn
11101
11102 @hook TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP
11103 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11104 invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11105 and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11106 the front end.
11107 @end deftypefn
11108
11109 @hook TARGET_INVALID_PARAMETER_TYPE
11110 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11111 invalid for functions to include parameters of type @var{type},
11112 or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11113 the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11114 @end deftypefn
11115
11116 @hook TARGET_INVALID_RETURN_TYPE
11117 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11118 invalid for functions to have return type @var{type},
11119 or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11120 the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11121 @end deftypefn
11122
11123 @hook TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE
11124 If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11125 @var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
11126 analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11127 front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11128 target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11129 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11130 @end deftypefn
11131
11132 @hook TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE
11133 If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11134 @var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
11135 or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
11136 This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
11137 conversion rules.
11138 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11139 @end deftypefn
11140
11141 @defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
11142 This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
11143 classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
11144 SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
11145 @end defmac
11146
11147 @defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11148 This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11149 NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11150 @end defmac
11151
11152 @defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11153 Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
11154 to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
11155 call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11156 and the associated definitions of those functions.
11157 @end defmac
11158
11159 @hook TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY
11160 Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11161 necessary.
11162 @end deftypefn
11163
11164 @hook TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX
11165 This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
11166 different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
11167 argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11168 is needed.
11169 @end deftypefn
11170
11171 @hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS
11172 When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11173 arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11174 stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11175 debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11176 @code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11177 cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11178 to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11179 false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11180 @end deftypefn
11181
11182 @hook TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11183 On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11184 a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11185 is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11186 is computed from this register using immediate addition or
11187 subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
11188 the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11189 available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11190 constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11191 down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11192 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11193 accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11194 value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11195 MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11196 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
11197 is zero, which disables this optimization. @end deftypevr